blob: 0c22b8265fe20718b4cd95c968e7bb9f951f94bf [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaueaded982022-12-01 15:25:34 +01005 version 2.8
Willy Tarreaufc0ad292023-03-10 16:28:37 +01006 2023/03/10
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001018.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
1038.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02001239.7. Bandwidth limitation
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2 and HTTP/3.
193This time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all
194streams are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200198
199HTTP/3 is implemented over QUIC, itself implemented over UDP. QUIC solves the
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +0200200head of line blocking at transport level by means of independently treated
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200201streams. Indeed, when experiencing loss, an impacted stream does not affect the
202other streams.
203
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
205connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
206leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100207start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
208processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
209waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200210
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200211HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100212 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
213 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100214 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100215 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200216 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100217
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219
2201.2. HTTP request
221-----------------
222
223First, let's consider this HTTP request :
224
225 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100226 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
228 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
229 3 User-agent: my small browser
230 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
231 5 Accept: image/png
232
233
2341.2.1. The Request line
235-----------------------
236
237Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
238
239 - a METHOD : GET
240 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
242
243All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
244which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
245followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
246is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
247desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
248the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
249
250The URI itself can have several forms :
251
252 - A "relative URI" :
253
254 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
257 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
258
259 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
260
261 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
262
263 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
264 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
265 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
266 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
267 must accept this form too.
268
269 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
270 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
271 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
274 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
275 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
276 other protocols too.
277
278In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
279mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
280on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
281It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
282specific to the language, framework or application in use.
283
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100284HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100285assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
2881.2.2. The request headers
289--------------------------
290
291The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
292beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
293an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
294Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
295values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
296encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
297the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
298define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
299
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100300Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100302"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200303as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
304normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
305representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
306HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200307
308The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
309that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
310is one valid form of empty line.
311
312Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
313headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
314about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
315application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
316
317Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000318 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
320 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
321 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
322
323
3241.3. HTTP response
325------------------
326
327An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
328messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
329
330 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100331 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
333 2 Content-length: 350
334 3 Content-Type: text/html
335
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
337codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
338response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100339continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
340the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
341following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
342sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
343(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
344correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
345such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
346state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400347over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100348if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
349information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003521.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353------------------------
354
355Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
356
357 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
358 - a status code : 200
359 - a reason : OK
360
361The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100362 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
363 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
364 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
365 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
366 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000368Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100369"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
371messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
372or "Authentication Required".
373
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100374HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375
376 Code When / reason
377 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
378 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
379 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
380 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100381 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
382 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 400 for an invalid or too large request
384 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
385 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100387 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100389 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
390 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400391 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200392 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400393 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100394 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200395 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200396 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200397 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
398 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
399 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
400
401The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
4024.2).
403
404
4051.3.2. The response headers
406---------------------------
407
408Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
409the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
410details.
411
412
4132. Configuring HAProxy
414----------------------
415
4162.1. Configuration file format
417------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
419HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
420
421 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700423 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100424 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200425
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100426The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
427a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100428
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100429 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
430
431 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
432
433 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
434 tab characters
435
436 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
437 keyword sequences listed in this document
438
439 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
440 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
441 parts of the configuration, or expressions
442
443 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
444 are supported
445
446 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
447 section
448
449This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
450generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
451figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
452
453First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
454the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
455a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
456word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
457follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
458the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
459the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
460the parts that need to be addressed.
461
462A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
463requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
464extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
465the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
466section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
467section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
468not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
469
470A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
471each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
472a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
473start a new one.
474
475Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
476that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
477applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
478"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
479processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
480ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
481which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
482In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
483of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
484identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
485such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4862, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
487
488 listen foo
489 bind :80
490
491 listen bar
492 bind :81
493
494Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
495spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
496of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
497following configurations are strictly equivalent:
498
499 global#this is the global section
500 daemon#daemonize
501 frontend foo
502 mode http # or tcp
503
504and:
505
506 global
507 daemon
508
509 # this is the public web frontend
510 frontend foo
511 mode http
512
513The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
514new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
515other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
516section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
517section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
518at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
519
520Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
521are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
522editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
523support automatic indent.
524
525In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
526positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
527modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
528anymore, and is not recommended.
529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200530
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005312.2. Quoting and escaping
532-------------------------
533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
535that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
536possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
537in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
538('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200539
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100540This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
541very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
542the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
543also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
544delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
545word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
546remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100548If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
549(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
550
551Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
552backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200553
554 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
555 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
556 \\ to use a backslash
557 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
558 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
559
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100560In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
561C-language representation:
562
563 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
564 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
565 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
566 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
567
568Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
569or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
570of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200571
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100572 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200573 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
574 # hash as a comment start
575
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
577evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
578dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
579backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200580
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100581Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
582character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
583is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
586entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
587name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
588represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
589hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100591 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
592 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
593 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
594 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
595 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
596 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
597 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
598 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
599 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
600 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
601 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200602
603 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200605 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
606 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
607 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
608 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
609 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
610
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100611There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
612necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
613by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
614they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
615escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
616characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
617case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
618if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
619own quotes.
620
621The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600622quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500623not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100624quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
625
626Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
627arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
628
629 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
631
632Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
633"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
634cannot write:
635
636 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
637
638because we would like the string to cut like this:
639
640 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
641 |---------|----|-|
642 arg1 _/ / /
643 arg2 __________/ /
644 arg3 ______________/
645
646but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
647parenthesis then garbage:
648
649 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
650 |--------|--------|
651 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
652 trailing garbage _________/
653
654The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
655quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
656processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
657this word:
658
659 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
660 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
661 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
662
663So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
664still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
665the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
666the second level:
667
668 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
669 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
670 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
671 |---------||----|-|
672 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
673 arg2=blah ___________/ /
674 arg3=g _______________/
675
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500676Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100677double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
678
679 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
680 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
681 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
682 |---------||----|-|
683 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
684 arg2 ___________/ /
685 arg3 _______________/
686
687When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
688appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
689string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
690thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
691
692 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
693 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
694 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
695 |-------------| |-----||-|
696 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
697 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
698 arg3 ______________________/
699
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400700Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600701that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100702quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
703single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
704level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
705
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600706Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
707if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
708or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
709
710 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
711 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
712 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
713
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100714When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
715double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600716and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100717a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
718a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
719the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
720regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
721around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
722more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200723
724
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007252.3. Environment variables
726--------------------------
727
728HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
729interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
730configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
731optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
732shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200733underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
734list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
735arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100736before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
737use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
738next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
739existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200740
741 Example:
742
743 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
744
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100745 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200746
747 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
748
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200749Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
750file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200751
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200752* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
753 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
754
755* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
756 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
757 directory.
758
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +0100759* HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT: contains the value of the default HTTP log format as
760 defined in section 8.2.3 "HTTP log format". It can be used to override the
761 default log format without having to copy the whole original definition.
762
763 Example:
764 # Add the rule that gave the final verdict to the log
765 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT} lr=last_rule_file:last_rule_line"
766
767* HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for HTTPS log
768 format as defined in section 8.2.4 "HTTPS log format".
769
770* HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for TCP log format
771 as defined in section 8.2.2 "TCP log format".
772
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200773* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
774
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500775* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200776 processes, separated by semicolons.
777
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500778* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200779 CLI, separated by semicolons.
780
William Lallemandd4c0be62023-02-21 14:07:05 +0100781* HAPROXY_STARTUP_VERSION: contains the version used to start, in master-worker
782 mode this is the version which was used to start the master, even after
783 updating the binary and reloading.
784
Sébaastien Gross2a1bcf12023-02-23 12:54:25 -0500785* HAPROXY_BRANCH: contains the HAProxy branch version (such as "2.8"). It does
786 not contain the full version number. It can be useful in case of migration
787 if resources (such as maps or certificates) are in a path containing the
788 branch number.
789
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200790In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
791regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
792only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
793
794* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
795
796* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
797 starting at one.
798
799* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
800 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
801 first section.
802
803These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
804if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
805section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
806"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
807proxies.
808
809This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
810logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
811to name some config objects like servers for example.
812
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200813See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200814
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100815
8162.4. Conditional blocks
817-----------------------
818
819It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
820some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
821ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
822configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
823versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
824preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
825text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
826lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
827switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
828are defined to form conditional blocks:
829
830 - .if <condition>
831 - .elif <condition>
832 - .else
833 - .endif
834
835The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
836as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
837matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
838there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
839only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
840".elif" of a block.
841
842Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
843ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
844as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
845
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200846Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
847See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
848
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200849The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
850expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100851
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100852 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
853 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200854 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200855 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530856 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
857 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200858 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
859 from left to right until one returns false
860 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
861 from right to left until one returns true
862
863Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
864operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200865
866The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
867
868 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
869 exists, regardless of its contents
870
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200871 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
872 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
873 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
874
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200875 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
876 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
Christopher Fauleta1fdad72023-02-20 17:55:58 +0100877 - strstr(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the second string is found in the first one
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200878
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200879 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
880 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
881 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
882 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
883
884 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
885 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
886 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
887 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
888
Christopher Fauletc13f3022023-02-21 11:16:08 +0100889 - enabled(<opt>) : returns true if the option <opt> is enabled at
890 run-time. Only a subset of options are supported:
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +0100891 POLL, EPOLL, KQUEUE, EVPORTS, SPLICE,
892 GETADDRINFO, REUSEPORT, FAST-FORWARD,
893 SERVER-SSL-VERIFY-NONE
Christopher Fauletc13f3022023-02-21 11:16:08 +0100894
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200895Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100896
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200897 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
898 listen mwcli_px
899 bind :1111
900 ...
901 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100902
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200903 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
904 bind :80
905 .endif
906
907 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200908 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200909 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200910 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200911 .endif
912
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200913 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200914 bind :443 ssl crt ...
915 .endif
916
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200917 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
918 profiling.memory on
919 .endif
920
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200921 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
922 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
923 .endif
924
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200925Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100926
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200927 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100928 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
929 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
930 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
931
932Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
933"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
934fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
935provide advice to the user.
936
937Example:
938
939 .if "${A}"
940 .if "${B}"
941 .notice "A=1, B=1"
942 .elif "${C}"
943 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
944 .elif "${D}"
945 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
946 .else
947 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
948 .endif
949 .else
950 .notice "A=0"
951 .endif
952
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200953 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
954 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
955
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100956
9572.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958----------------
959
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100960Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100961values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
962otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
963numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
964for every keyword. Supported units are :
965
966 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
967 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
968 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
969 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
970 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
971 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
972
973
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009742.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200975-------------
976
977 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
978 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
979 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
980 global
981 daemon
982 maxconn 256
983
984 defaults
985 mode http
986 timeout connect 5000ms
987 timeout client 50000ms
988 timeout server 50000ms
989
990 frontend http-in
991 bind *:80
992 default_backend servers
993
994 backend servers
995 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
996
997
998 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
999 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
1000 global
1001 daemon
1002 maxconn 256
1003
1004 defaults
1005 mode http
1006 timeout connect 5000ms
1007 timeout client 50000ms
1008 timeout server 50000ms
1009
1010 listen http-in
1011 bind *:80
1012 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
1013
1014
1015Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
1016
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +01001017 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001018
1019
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010203. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001021--------------------
1022
1023Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
1024are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
1025of them have command-line equivalents.
1026
1027The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
1028
1029 * Process management and security
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001030 - 51degrees-allow-unmatched
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001031 - 51degrees-cache-size
1032 - 51degrees-data-file
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001033 - 51degrees-difference
1034 - 51degrees-drift
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001035 - 51degrees-property-name-list
1036 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001037 - 51degrees-use-performance-graph
1038 - 51degrees-use-predictive-graph
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001039 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001040 - chroot
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001041 - cluster-secret
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001042 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001043 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001044 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001045 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001046 - description
1047 - deviceatlas-json-file
1048 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001049 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001050 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001051 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001052 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001053 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001054 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001055 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001056 - group
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001057 - h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1058 - h1-case-adjust
1059 - h1-case-adjust-file
1060 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001061 - hard-stop-after
William Lallemandcfabb352022-05-12 10:51:15 +02001062 - httpclient.resolvers.id
1063 - httpclient.resolvers.prefer
1064 - httpclient.ssl.ca-file
1065 - httpclient.ssl.verify
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001066 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001067 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001068 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001069 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001071 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001072 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001073 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001074 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001075 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001076 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001077 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001078 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001079 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001080 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001081 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001082 - presetenv
1083 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001084 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001085 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001086 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001087 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001088 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001089 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001090 - ssl-default-bind-options
1091 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001092 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001093 - ssl-default-server-options
1094 - ssl-dh-param-file
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02001095 - ssl-propquery
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02001096 - ssl-provider
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02001097 - ssl-provider-path
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001098 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001099 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001100 - stats
1101 - strict-limits
1102 - uid
1103 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001104 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001105 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001106 - user
1107 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001108 - wurfl-data-file
1109 - wurfl-information-list
1110 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001111
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001112 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001113 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001114 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001115 - maxcompcpuusage
1116 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001117 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001118 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001119 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001120 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001121 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001122 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001123 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001124 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001125 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001126 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001127 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001128 - nokqueue
1129 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001130 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001131 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001132 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001133 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001134 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001135 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001136 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001137 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001138 - tune.buffers.limit
1139 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001140 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001141 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01001142 - tune.disable-fast-forward
Christopher Faulet760a3842023-02-20 14:33:46 +01001143 - tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001144 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001145 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001146 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001147 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001148 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001149 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001150 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001151 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001152 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001153 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001154 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001155 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001156 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1157 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001158 - tune.maxaccept
1159 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001160 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01001161 - tune.memory.hot-size
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001162 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02001163 - tune.peers.max-updates-at-once
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001164 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001165 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1166 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02001167 - tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02001168 - tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02001169 - tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01001170 - tune.quic.max-frame-loss
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02001171 - tune.quic.retry-threshold
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01001172 - tune.quic.socket-owner
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001173 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1174 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001175 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001176 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001177 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001178 - tune.sndbuf.client
1179 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01001180 - tune.stick-counters
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001181 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001182 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1183 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
1184 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001185 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1186 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001187 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001188 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1189 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001190 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +01001191 - tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay
1192 - tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001193 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001194 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001195 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1196 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1197 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001198 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1199 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001200
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001201 * Debugging
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02001202 - anonkey
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001203 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001204 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001205
1206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012073.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001208------------------------------------
1209
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100121051degrees-data-file <file path>
1211 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1212 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1213
1214 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001215 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001216
121751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1218 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1219 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1220 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1221
1222 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001223 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001224
122551degrees-property-separator <char>
1226 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1227 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1228
1229 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001230 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001231
123251degrees-cache-size <number>
1233 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1234 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1235 By default, this cache is disabled.
1236
1237 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001238 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001239
124051degrees-use-performance-graph { on | off }
1241 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the performance graph in
1242 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1243
1244 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001245 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001246
124751degrees-use-predictive-graph { on | off }
1248 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the predictive graph in
1249 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1250
1251 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001252 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001253
125451degrees-drift <number>
1255 Sets the drift value that a detection can allow.
1256
1257 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001258 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001259
126051degrees-difference <number>
1261 Sets the difference value that a detection can allow.
1262
1263 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001264 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001265
126651degrees-allow-unmatched { on | off }
1267 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of unmatched nodes in the
1268 detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1269
1270 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001271 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001272
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001273ca-base <dir>
1274 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001275 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1276 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1277 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001278
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001279chroot <jail dir>
1280 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1281 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1282 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1283 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1284 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001285 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001286
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001287close-spread-time <time>
1288 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1289 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1290 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1291 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1292 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1293 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1294 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1295 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001296 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1297 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1298 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1299 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1300 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001301
1302 Arguments :
1303 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001304 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1305 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001306
1307 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1308 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1309 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1310
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001311 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001312
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001313cluster-secret <secret>
1314 Define an ASCII string secret shared between several nodes belonging to the
1315 same cluster. It could be used for different usages. It is at least used to
1316 derive stateless reset tokens for all the QUIC connections instantiated by
1317 this process. This is also the case to derive secrets used to encrypt Retry
Amaury Denoyelle28ea31c2022-11-14 16:18:46 +01001318 tokens.
1319
1320 If this parameter is not set, a random value will be selected on process
1321 startup. This allows to use features which rely on it, albeit with some
1322 limitations.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001323
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001324cpu-map [auto:]<thread-group>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1325 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a thread group or a thread
1326 to a specific CPU set. This means that the designated threads will never run
1327 on other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for individual
1328 threads or thread groups. The first argument is a thread group range,
1329 optionally followed by a thread set. These ranges have the following format:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001330
1331 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1332
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001333 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001334 word size. Any group IDs above 'thread-groups' and any thread IDs above the
1335 machine's word size are ignored. All thread numbers are relative to the group
1336 they belong to. It is possible to specify a range with two such number
1337 delimited by a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all threads at once
1338 using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just
1339 like with the "thread" bind directive. The second and forthcoming arguments
1340 are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the
1341 first CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside
1342 of Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to
1343 either 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the
1344 processes or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously,
1345 multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will
1346 replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001347
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001348 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1349 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1350 on the machine's word size.
1351
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001352 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the thread set to let HAProxy
1353 automatically bind a set of threads to a CPU by incrementing threads and
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001354 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1355 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001356 highest bound. Having both a group and a thread range with the "auto:"
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001357 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1358 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001359
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001360 Note that group ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a lone
1361 number designates a thread group and must be 1 if thread-groups are not used,
1362 and specifying a thread range or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of
1363 it if thread groups are not used. Finally, "1" is strictly equivalent to
1364 "1/all" and designates all threads in the group.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001365
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001366 Examples:
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001367 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first group on the
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001368 # first 4 CPUs
1369
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001370 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1371 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001372 # word size.
1373
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001374 # all these lines bind thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001375 # and so on.
1376 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1377 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1378 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1379
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001380 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1381 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1382 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1383 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001384
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001385 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1386 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1387 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001388
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001389 # map 40 threads of those 4 groups to individual CPUs
1390 cpu-map auto:1/1-10 0-9
1391 cpu-map auto:2/1-10 10-19
1392 cpu-map auto:3/1-10 20-29
1393 cpu-map auto:4/1-10 30-39
1394
1395 # Map 80 threads to one physical socket and 80 others to another socket
1396 # without forcing assignment. These are split into 4 groups since no
1397 # group may have more than 64 threads.
1398 cpu-map 1/1-40 0-39 80-119 # node0, siblings 0 & 1
1399 cpu-map 2/1-40 0-39 80-119
1400 cpu-map 3/1-40 40-79 120-159 # node1, siblings 0 & 1
1401 cpu-map 4/1-40 40-79 120-159
1402
1403
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001404crt-base <dir>
1405 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001406 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1407 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001408
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001409daemon
1410 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1411 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001412 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1413 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001414
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001415default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001416 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001417 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1418 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1419 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1420 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1421 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1422 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1423 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1424 not start with a slash ('/'):
1425 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1426 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1427
1428 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1429 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1430 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1431 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1432 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1433 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1434 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1435 each of them.
1436
1437 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1438 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1439 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1440 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1441 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1442 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1443 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1444 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1445
1446 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1447 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001448 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001449 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1450 made easily relocatable.
1451
1452 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1453 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1454 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1455 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1456 consistent across all configuration files.
1457
1458 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1459 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1460 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1461 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1462 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1463 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1464 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1465 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1466
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001467description <text>
1468 Add a text that describes the instance.
1469
1470 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1471 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1472 "<" and ">" characters.
1473
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001474deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1475 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001476 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001477
1478deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001479 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001480 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1481
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001482deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001483 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1484 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1485 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001486
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001487deviceatlas-separator <char>
1488 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1489 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1490
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001491expose-experimental-directives
1492 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1493 the config file will be rejected.
1494
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001495external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001496 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1497 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001498 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1499 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1500 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1501 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1502 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001503
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001504fd-hard-limit <number>
1505 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1506 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1507 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1508 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1509 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1510 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1511 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1512 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1513 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
1514 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. In the example below,
1515 no other setting is specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt
1516 to the lower of "fd-hard-limit" and the system-imposed limit:
1517
1518 global
1519 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1520 fd-hard-limit 50000
1521
1522 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1523
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001524gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001525 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001526 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1527 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001528 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001529 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001530 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001531
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001532grace <time>
1533 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1534
1535 Arguments :
1536 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1537 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1538 soft-stop operation.
1539
1540 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1541 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1542 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1543 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1544 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1545 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1546 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1547 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1548 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1549
1550 Example:
1551
1552 global
1553 grace 10s
1554
1555 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1556 frontend ext-check
1557 bind :9999
1558 monitor-uri /ext-check
1559 monitor fail if { stopping }
1560
1561 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1562 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1563 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1564 SIGUSR1 signal.
1565
1566 Example:
1567
1568 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1569 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1570 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1571 frontend ext-check
1572 bind :9999
1573 monitor-uri /ext-check
1574 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1575
1576 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1577
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001578group <group name>
1579 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1580 See also "gid" and "user".
1581
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001582h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1583 Does not reject HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1584
1585 While It is explicitly allowed in HTTP/1.1, HTTP/1.0 is not clear on this
1586 point and some old servers don't expect any payload and never look for body
1587 length (via Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding headers). It means that some
1588 intermediaries may properly handle the payload for HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE
1589 requests, while some others may totally ignore it. That may lead to security
1590 issues because a request smuggling attack is possible. Thus, by default,
1591 HAProxy rejects HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1592
1593 However, it may be an issue with some old clients. In this case, this global
1594 option may be set.
1595
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001596h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1597 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1598 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1599 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1600 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001601 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001602 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1603 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1604 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1605 specified in a proxy.
1606
1607 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1608 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1609 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1610 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1611 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1612 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1613 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1614
1615 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1616 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1617 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1618 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1619 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1620
1621 Example:
1622 global
1623 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1624
1625 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1626 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1627
1628h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1629 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1630 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1631 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1632 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1633 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1634 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1635 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1636 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1637
1638 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1639 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1640 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1641
1642 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1643 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1644
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001645h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1646 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1647 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1648 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1649 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1650 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1651 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1652 the keyword with "no'.
1653
1654hard-stop-after <time>
1655 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1656
1657 Arguments :
1658 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1659 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1660 SIGUSR1 signal.
1661
1662 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1663 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1664 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1665
1666 Example:
1667 global
1668 hard-stop-after 30s
1669
1670 See also: grace
1671
1672httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
1673 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
1674 to resolve.
1675
1676 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
1677 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
1678
1679 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1680 configuration error if it fails to load.
1681
1682httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
1683 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
1684 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
1685 option is "ipv6".
1686
William Lallemandde1803f2022-05-04 18:14:25 +02001687httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
1688 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
1689 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
1690 server line.
1691
1692 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1693 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
1694 will be disabled for the httpclient.
1695
1696 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1697 configuration error if it fails.
1698
1699httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
1700 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
1701 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
1702
1703 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1704 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
1705
1706 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1707 configuration error if it fails.
1708
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001709insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001710 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001711 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1712 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1713 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1714 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1715 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1716 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1717 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001718 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001719 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1720 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1721 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1722 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1723 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1724 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1725 disable it.
1726
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001727insecure-setuid-wanted
1728 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1729 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1730 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1731 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001732 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001733 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001734 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001735 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1736 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001737 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001738 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1739 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1740 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1741 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1742
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001743issuers-chain-path <dir>
1744 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1745 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1746 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001747 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001748 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1749 "issuers-chain-path".
1750 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1751 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1752 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1753 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1754 will share the chain in memory.
1755
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001756localpeer <name>
1757 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1758 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1759 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1760 the configuration parsing.
1761
1762 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1763 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1764
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001765log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001766 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001767 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001768 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001769 configured with "log global".
1770
1771 <address> can be one of:
1772
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001773 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001774 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1775 port).
1776
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001777 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1778 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1779 port).
1780
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001781 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001782 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1783 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001784 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001785
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001786 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1787 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1788 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1789 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1790 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1791 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1792 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1793 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1794 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1795 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001796 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001797 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1798 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1799 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001800 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1801 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001802
1803 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1804 "fd@2", see above.
1805
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001806 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1807 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1808 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1809 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1810 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1811
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001812 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1813 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001814
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001815 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1816 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1817 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1818 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1819 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1820 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1821 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1822 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1823 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1824 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001825 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1826 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001827
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001828 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1829 one of the following :
1830
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001831 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1832 field is stripped. This is the default.
1833 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1834 rfc3164.
1835
1836 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001837 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1838
1839 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1840 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1841
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001842 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1843 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1844 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1845 designed to be used with a local log server.
1846
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001847 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1848 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1849 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1850 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1851 logger consumes.
1852
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001853 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1854 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1855 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1856 used with a local log server.
1857
1858 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1859 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1860 designed to be used with a local log server.
1861
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001862 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1863 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1864 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1865 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1866
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001867 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1868 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1869 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1870 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1871 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1872
1873 <sample_size>
1874 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1875 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1876 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1877 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1878 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1879
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001880 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001881
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001882 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1883 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1884 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1885
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001886 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1887 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1888 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1889 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001890
1891 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001892 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1893 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1894 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1895 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1896 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1897 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001898
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001899 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001900
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001901log-send-hostname [<string>]
1902 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1903 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1904 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1905 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1906 the logs.
1907
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001908log-tag <string>
1909 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1910 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1911 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001912 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001913
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001914lua-load <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001915 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1916 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1917 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1918 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1919 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1920 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001921 used multiple times.
1922
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001923 args are available in the lua file using the code below in the body of the
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001924 file. Do not forget that Lua arrays start at index 1. A "local" variable
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001925 declared in a file is available in the entire file and not available on
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001926 other files.
1927
1928 local args = table.pack(...)
1929
1930lua-load-per-thread <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001931 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1932 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1933 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1934 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1935 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1936 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1937 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1938 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1939 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1940 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1941 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1942 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1943 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1944 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1945 times.
1946
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001947 See lua-load for usage of args.
1948
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001949lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1950 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1951 variable.
1952 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1953 to "path".
1954
1955 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1956 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1957 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1958 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1959 will be checked earlier.
1960
1961 As an example by specifying the following path:
1962
1963 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1964 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1965
1966 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1967 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1968 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1969 paths if that does not exist either.
1970
1971 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1972 documentation.
1973
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001974master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001975 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1976 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1977 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001978 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001979 or daemon mode.
1980
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001981 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1982 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1983 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1984 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1985 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001986
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001987 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001988
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001989mworker-max-reloads <number>
1990 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001991 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001992 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1993 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1994 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1995
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001996nbthread <number>
1997 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001998 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1999 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
2000 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
2001 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
2002 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
2003 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
2004 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02002005
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01002006no-quic
2007 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
2008 change without deprecation in the future.
2009
2010 Disable QUIC transport protocol. All the QUIC listeners will still be created.
2011 But they will not bind their addresses. Hence, no QUIC traffic will be
2012 processed by haproxy. See also "quic_enabled" sample fetch.
2013
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002014numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01002015 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
2016 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
2017 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
2018 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
2019 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
2020 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
2021 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
2022 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
2023 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
2024 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002025
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002026pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09002027 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
2028 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
2029 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
2030 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002031
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02002032pp2-never-send-local
2033 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
2034 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
2035 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
2036 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
2037 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
2038 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
2039 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
2040 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
2041 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
2042 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
2043 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
2044
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002045presetenv <name> <value>
2046 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2047 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
2048 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
2049 and "unsetenv".
2050
2051resetenv [<name> ...]
2052 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
2053 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
2054 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
2055 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
2056 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
2057 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
2058 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
2059 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
2060
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002061server-state-base <directory>
2062 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002063 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
2064 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02002065
2066server-state-file <file>
2067 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
2068 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
2069 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
2070 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
2071 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
2072 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
2073 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
2074 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002075 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
2076 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002077
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002078set-dumpable
2079 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
2080 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
2081 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
2082 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
2083 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
2084 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
2085 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
2086 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
2087 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
2088 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
2089 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
2090 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
2091 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
2092 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
2093 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
2094 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
2095 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
2096 leaves a core where expected when dying.
2097
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002098set-var <var-name> <expr>
2099 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
2100 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2101 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2102 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
2103 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
2104 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002105 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002106 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
2107 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2108
2109 Example:
2110 global
2111 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
2112 set-var proc.prio int(100)
2113 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
2114
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002115set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
2116 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
2117 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2118 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2119 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
2120 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
2121 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
2122 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
2123 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
2124 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2125 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
2126
2127 Example:
2128 global
2129 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
2130 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
2131
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002132setenv <name> <value>
2133 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2134 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
2135 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
2136 and "unsetenv".
2137
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002138ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
2139 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2140 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002141 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002142 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002143 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2144 information and recommendations see e.g.
2145 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2146 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
2147 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
2148 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002149
2150ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2151 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2152 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
2153 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
2154 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2155 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002156 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2157 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2158 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002159 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002160
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02002161ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
2162 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2163 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
2164 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
2165 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
2166 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2167
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002168ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
2169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2170 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
2171 keyword to see available options.
2172
2173 Example:
2174 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02002175 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002176
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002177ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
2178 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2179 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002180 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002181 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002182 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2183 information and recommendations see e.g.
2184 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2185 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2186 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2187 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2188 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002189
2190ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2191 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2192 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2193 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2194 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2195 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002196 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2197 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2198 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2199 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002200
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002201ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2202 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2203 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2204 keyword to see available options.
2205
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002206ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2207 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2208 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2209 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002210 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002211 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002212 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002213 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2214 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2215 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2216 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002217 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2218 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2219 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2220
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02002221ssl-propquery <query>
2222 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2223 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to define a default property
2224 string used when fetching algorithms in providers. It behave the same way as
2225 the openssl propquery option and it follows the same syntax (described in
2226 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man3.0/man7/property.html). For instance, if you
2227 have two providers loaded, the foo one and the default one, the propquery
2228 "?provider=foo" allows to pick the algorithm implementations provided by the
2229 foo provider by default, and to fallback on the default provider's one if it
2230 was not found.
2231
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002232ssl-provider <name>
2233 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2234 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to load a provider during init.
2235 If loading is successful, any capabilities provided by the loaded provider
2236 might be used by HAProxy. Multiple 'ssl-provider' options can be specified in
2237 a configuration file. The providers will be loaded in their order of
2238 appearance.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002239
2240 Please note that loading a provider explicitly prevents OpenSSL from loading
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002241 the 'default' provider automatically. OpenSSL also allows to define the
2242 providers that should be loaded directly in its configuration file
2243 (openssl.cnf for instance) so it is not necessary to use this 'ssl-provider'
2244 option to load providers. The "show ssl providers" CLI command can be used to
2245 show all the providers that were successfully loaded.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002246
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002247 The default search path of OpenSSL provider can be found in the output of the
2248 "openssl version -a" command. If the provider is in another directory, you
2249 can set the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable, which takes the directory
2250 where your provider can be found.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002251
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02002252 See also "ssl-propquery" and "ssl-provider-path".
2253
2254ssl-provider-path <path>
2255 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2256 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to specify the search path that
2257 is to be used by OpenSSL for looking for providers. It behaves the same way
2258 as the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable. It will be used for any
2259 following 'ssl-provider' option or until a new 'ssl-provider-path' is
2260 defined.
2261 See also "ssl-provider".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002262
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002263ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2264 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2265 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002266 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002267 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002268 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2269
2270 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002271
2272 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2273 and won't try to remove them.
2274
2275 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2276
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002277ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002278 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002279 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2280 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2281 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002282
2283 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2284 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2285 optimize the startup time.
2286
2287 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2288 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2289 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2290
2291 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002292 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002293
2294 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002295 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2296 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002297
2298 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2299 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2300 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2301 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2302 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002303 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002304
2305 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002306 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002307 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2308 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2309 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2310 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2311 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002312 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002313
2314 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2315
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002316 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002317 a cert bundle.
2318
2319 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2320 separately in several "crt".
2321
2322 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2323 since files are loading separately.
2324
2325 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2326 required to commit them.
2327
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002328 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002329 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002330
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002331 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2332 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2333 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002334
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002335 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2336 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2337 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002338
2339 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002340 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2341 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002342
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002343 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2344 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2345
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002346 The default behavior is "all".
2347
2348 Example:
2349 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2350 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2351 ssl-load-extra-files none
2352
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002353 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2354 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002355
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002356ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2357 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2358 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2359 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2360
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002361ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002362 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002363 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2364 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2365 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2366 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2367 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2368 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002369 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002370
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002371stats maxconn <connections>
2372 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2373 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2374
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002375stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2376 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2377 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2378 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002379 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002380 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002381
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002382 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2383 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2384 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002385
2386stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2387 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2388 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002389 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002390
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002391strict-limits
2392 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2393 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2394 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2395 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2396 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002397
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002398thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2399 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2400 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2401 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2402 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2403 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2404 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2405 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2406 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2407 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2408
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002409thread-groups <number>
2410 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2411 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
Willy Tarreau856d56d2022-07-15 21:46:55 +02002412 moment, the default value is 1. Thread groups make it possible to reduce
2413 sharing between threads to limit contention, at the expense of some extra
2414 configuration efforts. It is also the only way to use more than 64 threads
2415 since up to 64 threads per group may be configured. The maximum number of
2416 groups is configured at compile time and defaults to 16. See also "nbthread".
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002417
Willy Tarreau9fd05422022-11-16 17:29:12 +01002418trace <args...>
2419 This command configures one "trace" subsystem statement. Each of them can be
2420 found in the management manual, and follow the exact same syntax. Only one
2421 statement per line is permitted (i.e. if some long trace configurations using
2422 semi-colons are to be imported, they must be placed one per line). Any output
2423 that the "trace" command would produce will be emitted during the parsing
2424 step of the section. Most of the time these will be errors and warnings, but
2425 certain incomplete commands might list permissible choices. This command is
2426 not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by developers
2427 along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally marked as
2428 experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must appear on a
2429 line before any "trace" statement. Note that these directives are parsed on
2430 the fly, so referencing a ring buffer that is only declared further will not
2431 work. For such use cases it is suggested to place another "global" section
2432 with only the "trace" statements after the declaration of that ring. It is
2433 important to keep in mind that depending on the trace level and details,
2434 enabling traces can severely degrade the global performance. Please refer to
2435 the management manual for the statements syntax.
2436
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002437uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002438 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002439 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2440 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2441 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2442
2443ulimit-n <number>
2444 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2445 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002446 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2447 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002448
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002449 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2450 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2451 manually specify this value.
2452
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002453 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2454
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002455unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2456 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2457
2458 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2459 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2460 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2461 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2462 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002463 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002464 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2465 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2466 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2467 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2468
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002469unsetenv [<name> ...]
2470 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2471 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2472 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2473 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2474 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2475 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2476 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2477
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002478user <user name>
2479 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2480 See also "uid" and "group".
2481
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002482node <name>
2483 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2484
2485 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2486 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2487 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2488 traffic.
2489
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002490wurfl-cache-size <size>
2491 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2492 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2493 - "0" : no cache is used.
2494 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002495
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002496 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2497 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002498
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002499wurfl-data-file <file path>
2500 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2501 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2502
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002503 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002504 with USE_WURFL=1.
2505
2506wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2507 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2508 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2509 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2510
2511 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2512
2513 Valid WURFL properties are:
2514 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2515
2516 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2517 device.
2518
2519 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2520 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2521
2522 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2523 particular web request.
2524
2525 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2526 used Libwurfl API version.
2527
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002528 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2529 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2530
2531 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2532 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2533
2534 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2535
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002536 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002537 with USE_WURFL=1.
2538
2539wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2540 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2541 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2542
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002543 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002544 with USE_WURFL=1.
2545
2546wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2547 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2548 thus before the chroot.
2549
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002550 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002551 with USE_WURFL=1.
2552
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025533.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002554-----------------------
2555
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002556busy-polling
2557 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2558 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2559 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2560 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2561 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2562 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2563 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2564 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2565 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2566 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2567 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2568 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2569 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2570 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2571 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2572 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2573 "poll" pollers.
2574
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002575 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2576 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2577 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2578
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002579max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002580 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002581 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2582 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2583 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2584 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2585 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2586 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2587 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2588
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002589maxcompcpuusage <number>
2590 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2591 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2592 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2593 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2594 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2595 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2596 and from introducing high latencies.
2597
2598maxcomprate <number>
2599 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2600 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2601 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2602 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2603 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2604 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2605 default value.
2606
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002607maxconn <number>
2608 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2609 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2610 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002611 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2612 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2613 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2614 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002615 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2616 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2617 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2618 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2619 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002620 also be automatic). In any case, the fd-hard-limit applies if set.
2621
2622 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002623
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002624maxconnrate <number>
2625 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2626 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2627 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2628 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2629 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2630 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2631 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2632 fairness.
2633
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002634maxpipes <number>
2635 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2636 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2637 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2638 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2639 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2640 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2641
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002642maxsessrate <number>
2643 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2644 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2645 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2646 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2647 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2648 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2649 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2650 fairness.
2651
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002652maxsslconn <number>
2653 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2654 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2655 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2656 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2657 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2658 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2659 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002660 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2661 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2662 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2663 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002664 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002665 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2666 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002667
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002668maxsslrate <number>
2669 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2670 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2671 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2672 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2673 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2674 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2675 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2676 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2677 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2678 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2679
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002680maxzlibmem <number>
2681 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2682 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2683 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002684 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2685 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2686 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2687
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002688no-memory-trimming
2689 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2690 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2691 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2692 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2693 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2694 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2695 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2696 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2697 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2698 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2699 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2700 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2701 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2702 not suffer from such a problem.
2703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002704noepoll
2705 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2706 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002707 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002708
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002709noevports
2710 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2711 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2712 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2713 also "nopoll".
2714
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002715nogetaddrinfo
2716 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2717 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2718
2719nokqueue
2720 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2721 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2722 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2723
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002724nopoll
2725 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2726 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002727 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002728 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2729 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002730
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002731noreuseport
2732 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2733 command line argument "-dR".
2734
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002735nosplice
2736 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002737 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002738 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002739 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002740 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2741 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2742 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2743 "option splice-response".
2744
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002745profiling.memory { on | off }
2746 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2747 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2748 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2749 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2750 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2751 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2752 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2753 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2754 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2755
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002756profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2757 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2758 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2759 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2760 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002761 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002762 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2763 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2764 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2765 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2766
2767 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2768 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2769 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2770 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2771 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002772 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2773 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2774 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2775 CLI.
2776
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002777spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002778 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2779 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2780 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2781 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2782 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2783 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002784
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002785ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002786 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002787 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002788 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002789 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002790 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2791 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2792 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002793 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2794 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002795 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2796 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2797 openssl configuration file uses:
2798 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2799
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002800ssl-mode-async
2801 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002802 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002803 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2804 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002805 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002806 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002807 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002808
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002809tune.buffers.limit <number>
2810 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2811 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2812 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2813 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2814 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002815 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002816 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2817 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2818 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2819 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2820 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2821 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2822 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2823 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002824 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002825
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002826tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2827 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2828 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2829 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002830 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002831
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002832tune.bufsize <number>
2833 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2834 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2835 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2836 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2837 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2838 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2839 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002840 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2841 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002842 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002843 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002844 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002845 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2846 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002847
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002848tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2849 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2850 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2851 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2852 this value. The default value is 1.
2853
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01002854tune.disable-fast-forward [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2855 Disables the data fast-forwarding. It is a mechanism to optimize the data
2856 forwarding by passing data directly from a side to the other one without
2857 waking the stream up. Thanks to this directive, it is possible to disable
2858 this optimization. Note it also disable any kernel tcp splicing. This command
2859 is not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by
2860 developers along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally
2861 marked as experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must
2862 appear on a line before this directive.
2863
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002864tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002865 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2866 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2867 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
Willy Tarreau0c4348c2023-03-21 09:24:53 +01002868 failures are handled gracefully. When not set, the ratio is 0. However the
2869 command-line "-dMfail" option automatically sets it to 1% failure rate so that
2870 it is not necessary to change the configuration for testing.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002871
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002872tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2873 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2874 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2875 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2876 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2877 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2878
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002879tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2880 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2881 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2882 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2883 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2884 change it.
2885
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002886tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2887 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002888 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002889 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Glenn Strauss0012f892022-06-04 22:11:50 -04002890 The default value is 65536, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002891 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2892 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2893 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2894 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2895
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002896tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2897 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2898 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2899 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2900 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2901 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002902 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002903 recommended not to change this value.
2904
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002905tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002906 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002907 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002908 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002909 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2910 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2911 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2912 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2913
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002914tune.http.cookielen <number>
2915 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2916 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2917 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2918 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2919 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2920 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2921 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2922 to change this value.
2923
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002924tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002925 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2926 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002927 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002928 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002929 configuration directives too.
2930 The default value is 1024.
2931
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002932tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2933 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2934 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2935 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2936 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2937 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2938 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002939 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2940 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2941 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002942
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002943tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2944 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2945 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2946 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2947 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2948 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2949 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002950 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2951 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2952 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2953 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2954 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002955
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002956tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002957 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002958 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2959 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2960 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2961 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002962 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002963 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002964 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002965 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2966
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002967tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2968 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2969 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2970 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2971 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2972 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2973 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2974 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2975 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2976 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2977
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002978tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2979 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002980 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002981 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2982 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002983 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002984 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2985 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2986
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002987tune.lua.maxmem
2988 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2989 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2990 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2991 memory.
2992
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002993tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2994 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002995 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2996 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002997 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002998
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002999tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
3000 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
3001 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
3002 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003003 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003004
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003005tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
3006 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
3007 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
3008 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
3009 check servers.
3010
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003011tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01003012 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
3013 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01003014 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
3015 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
3016 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
3017 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
3018 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
3019 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
3020 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
3021 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
3022 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003023
3024tune.maxpollevents <number>
3025 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
3026 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
3027 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
3028 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
3029 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
3030
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02003031tune.maxrewrite <number>
3032 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
3033 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
3034 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
3035 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
3036 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
3037 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
3038 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
3039 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
3040 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
3041 bufsize.
3042
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01003043tune.memory.hot-size <number>
3044 Sets the per-thread amount of memory that will be kept hot in the local cache
3045 and will never be recoverable by other threads. Access to this memory is very
3046 fast (lockless), and having enough is critical to maintain a good performance
3047 level under extreme thread contention. The value is expressed in bytes, and
3048 the default value is configured at build time via CONFIG_HAP_POOL_CACHE_SIZE
3049 which defaults to 524288 (512 kB). A larger value may increase performance in
3050 some usage scenarios, especially when performance profiles show that memory
3051 allocation is stressed a lot. Experience shows that a good value sits between
3052 once to twice the per CPU core L2 cache size. Too large values will have a
3053 negative impact on performance by making inefficient use of the L3 caches in
3054 the CPUs, and will consume larger amounts of memory. It is recommended not to
3055 change this value, or to proceed in small increments. In order to completely
3056 disable the per-thread CPU caches, using a very small value could work, but
3057 it is better to use "-dMno-cache" on the command-line.
3058
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003059tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
3060 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
3061 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
3062 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
3063 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
3064 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
3065 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
3066 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
3067 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
3068 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02003069 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
3070 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003071 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
3072 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
3073 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
3074 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
3075 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
3076 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
3077 setting this parameter to 0.
3078
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02003079tune.peers.max-updates-at-once <number>
3080 Sets the maximum number of stick-table updates that haproxy will try to
3081 process at once when sending messages. Retrieving the data for these updates
3082 requires some locking operations which can be CPU intensive on highly
3083 threaded machines if unbound, and may also increase the traffic latency
3084 during the initial batched transfer between an older and a newer process.
3085 Conversely low values may also incur higher CPU overhead, and take longer
3086 to complete. The default value is 200 and it is suggested not to change it.
3087
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02003088tune.pipesize <number>
3089 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
3090 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
3091 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
3092 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
3093 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
3094 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
3095
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003096tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
3097 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003098 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003099 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
3100 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
3101 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
3102 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003103 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003104
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003105tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
3106 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003107 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003108 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
3109 default is 20.
3110
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003111tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit <number>
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003112 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3113 change without deprecation in the future.
3114
3115 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
3116 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
3117 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
3118 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003119 time-trip. Each buffer is tune.bufsize.
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003120
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003121tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout <timeout>
3122 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3123 change without deprecation in the future.
3124
3125 Sets the QUIC max_idle_timeout transport parameters in milliseconds for
3126 frontends which determines the period of time after which a connection silently
3127 closes if it has remained inactive during an effective period of time deduced
3128 from the two max_idle_timeout values announced by the two endpoints:
3129 - the minimum of the two values if both are not null,
3130 - the maximum if only one of them is not null,
3131 - if both values are null, this feature is disabled.
3132
3133 The default value is 30000.
3134
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003135tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi <number>
3136 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3137 change without deprecation in the future.
3138
3139 Sets the QUIC initial_max_streams_bidi transport parameter for frontends.
3140 This is the initial maximum number of bidirectional streams the remote peer
3141 will be authorized to open. This determines the number of concurrent client
3142 requests.
3143
3144 The default value is 100.
3145
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003146tune.quic.max-frame-loss <number>
3147 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3148 change without deprecation in the future.
3149
3150 Sets the limit for which a single QUIC frame can be marked as lost. If
3151 exceeded, the connection is considered as failing and is closed immediately.
3152
3153 The default value is 10.
3154
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003155tune.quic.retry-threshold <number>
3156 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3157 change without deprecation in the future.
3158
3159 Dynamically enables the Retry feature for all the configured QUIC listeners
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02003160 as soon as this number of half open connections is reached. A half open
3161 connection is a connection whose handshake has not already successfully
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003162 completed or failed. To be functional this setting needs a cluster secret to
3163 be set, if not it will be silently ignored (see "cluster-secret" setting).
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02003164 This setting will be also silently ignored if the use of QUIC Retry was
3165 forced (see "quic-force-retry").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003166
3167 The default value is 100.
3168
3169 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
3170 information about QUIC retry.
3171
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003172tune.quic.socket-owner { listener | connection }
3173 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3174 change without deprecation in the future.
3175
3176 Specifies how QUIC connections will use socket for receive/send operations.
3177 Connections can share listener socket or each connection can allocate its
3178 own socket.
3179
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003180 When default "connection" value is set, a dedicated socket will be allocated
3181 by every QUIC connections. This option is the preferred one to achieve the
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003182 best performance with a large QUIC traffic. This is also the only way to
Amaury Denoyellee1a0ee32023-02-28 15:11:09 +01003183 ensure soft-stop is conducted properly without data loss for QUIC connections
3184 and cases of transient errors during sendto() operation are handled
3185 efficiently. However, this relies on some advanced features from the UDP
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003186 network stack. If your platform is deemed not compatible, haproxy will
3187 automatically switch to "listener" mode on startup.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003188
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003189 The "listener" value indicates that QUIC transfers will occur on the shared
3190 listener socket. This option can be a good compromise for small traffic as it
3191 allows to reduce FD consumption. However, performance won't be optimal due to
Ilya Shipitsin5fa29b82022-12-07 09:46:19 +05003192 a higher CPU usage if listeners are shared across a lot of threads or a
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003193 large number of QUIC connections can be used simultaneously.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003194
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003195tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
3196tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
3197 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
3198 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3199 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003200 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003201 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003202 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3203 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3204
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003205tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003206 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003207 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
3208 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
3209 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
3210 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
3211
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003212tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003213 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01003214 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
3215 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
3216 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
3217 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
3218 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
3219 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
3220 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003221
3222tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
3223 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003224 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003225 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
3226 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
3227 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
3228 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
3229 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
3230 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
3231 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003232
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003233tune.sndbuf.client <number>
3234tune.sndbuf.server <number>
3235 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
3236 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3237 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003238 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003239 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003240 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3241 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3242 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
3243 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003244 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003245
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003246tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01003247 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01003248 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
3249 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
3250 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
3251 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
3252 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
3253 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
3254 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
3255 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
3256 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02003257 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
3258 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003259
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003260tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3261tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
3262 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3263 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3264 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3265 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
3266
3267tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3268 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3269 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3270 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3271 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
3272 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3273 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3274 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3275 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3276 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3277 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3278 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3279 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
3280
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003281tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02003282 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003283 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
3284 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
3285 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
3286 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
3287 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
3288
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003289tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
3290 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
3291 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
3292 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
3293 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
3294
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003295tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
3296 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
3297 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
3298 performances. This is disabled by default.
3299
3300 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
3301 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
3302
3303 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
3304
3305 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
3306
3307 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
3308
3309 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
3310 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
3311 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
3312
3313 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
3314 converted.
3315
3316 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
3317 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
3318 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
3319 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
3320 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
3321 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
3322 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02003323 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
3324 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003325
3326 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
3327
3328 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
3329 only need this line:
3330
3331 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
3332
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003333tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
3334 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003335 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003336 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
3337 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
3338 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
3339 being used for too long.
3340
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003341tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003342 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
3343 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
3344 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3345 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3346 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3347 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3348 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3349 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3350 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3351 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3352 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3353 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3354 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003355
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003356tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3357 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3358 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3359 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3360 1000 entries.
3361
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +01003362tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay <number>
3363 Sets the maximum interval between two automatic updates of the same OCSP
3364 response. This time is expressed in seconds and defaults to 3600 (1 hour). It
3365 must be set to a higher value than "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay". See
3366 option "ocsp-update" for more information about the auto update mechanism.
3367
3368tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay <number>
3369 Sets the minimum interval between two automatic updates of the same OCSP
3370 response. This time is expressed in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 minutes).
3371 It is particularly useful for OCSP response that do not have explicit
3372 expiration times. It must be set to a lower value than
3373 "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay". See option "ocsp-update" for more
3374 information about the auto update mechanism.
3375
3376 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3377 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3378 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3379 1000 entries.
3380
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003381tune.stick-counters <number>
3382 Sets the number of stick-counters that may be tracked at the same time by a
3383 connection or a request via "track-sc*" actions in "tcp-request" or
3384 "http-request" rules. The defaut value is set at build time by the macro
3385 MAX_SESS_STK_CTR, and defaults to 3. With this setting it is possible to
3386 change the value and ignore the one passed at build time. Increasing this
3387 value may be needed when porting complex configurations to haproxy, but users
3388 are warned against the costs: each entry takes 16 bytes per connection and
3389 16 bytes per request, all of which need to be allocated and zeroed for all
3390 requests even when not used. As such a value of 10 will inflate the memory
3391 consumption per request by 320 bytes and will cause this memory to be erased
3392 for each request, which does have measurable CPU impacts. Conversely, when
3393 no "track-sc" rules are used, the value may be lowered (0 being valid to
3394 entirely disable stick-counters).
3395
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003396tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003397tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003398tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3399tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3400tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003401 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3402 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3403 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3404 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3405 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3406 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3407 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3408 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003409
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003410 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3411 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3412 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3413 all available space is consumed.
3414 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3415 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3416 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003417
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003418tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3419 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003420 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003421 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003422 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003423 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3424
3425tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3426 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3427 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003428 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3429 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003430
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034313.3. Debugging
3432--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003433
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003434anonkey <key>
3435 This sets the global anonymizing key to <key>, which must be a 32-bit number
3436 between 0 and 4294967295. This is the key that will be used by default by CLI
3437 commands when anonymized mode is enabled. This key may also be set at runtime
Amaury Denoyelledd3a33f2023-03-03 17:11:10 +01003438 from the CLI command "set anon global-key". See also command line argument
3439 "-dC" in the management manual.
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003440
Willy Tarreaue98d3852022-11-15 09:34:07 +01003441quick-exit
3442 This speeds up the old process exit upon reload by skipping the releasing of
3443 memory objects and listeners, since all of these are reclaimed by the
3444 operating system at the process' death. The gains are only marginal (in the
3445 order of a few hundred milliseconds for huge configurations at most). The
3446 main target usage in fact is when a bug is spotted in the deinit() code, as
3447 this allows to bypass it. It is better not to use this unless instructed to
3448 do so by developers.
3449
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003450quiet
3451 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3452 line argument "-q".
3453
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003454zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003455 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003456 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3457 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3458 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3459 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3460 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3461
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010034633.4. Userlists
3464--------------
3465It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3466http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3467it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3468
3469userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003470 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003471 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3472
3473group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003474 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003475 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3476 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3477
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003478user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3479 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003480 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3481 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003482 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3483 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3484 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3485 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003486
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003487 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3488 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3489 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3490 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3491 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3492 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3493 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003494 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003495 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003496
3497 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003498 userlist L1
3499 group G1 users tiger,scott
3500 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003501
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003502 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3503 user scott insecure-password elgato
3504 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003505
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003506 userlist L2
3507 group G1
3508 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003509
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003510 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3511 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3512 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003513
3514 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003515
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003516
35173.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003518----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003519It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003520several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003521instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003522values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3523type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3524values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3525active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3526switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3527present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3528watch it.
3529
3530Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3531known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3532the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3533process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3534during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3535tables.
3536
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003537Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3538that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3539each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003540
3541peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003542 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003543 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3544
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003545bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3546 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3547 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3548
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003549disabled
3550 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3551 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3552 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3553
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003554default-bind [param*]
3555 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3556
3557default-server [param*]
3558 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3559
3560 Arguments:
3561 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3562 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003563 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3564 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3565 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3566 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003567
3568 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3569
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003570enabled
3571 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3572 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003573
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003574log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003575 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3576 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3577 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3578 more details.
3579
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003580peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003581 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3582 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003583 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003584 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003585 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3586 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3587 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003588
3589 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3590 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3591
3592 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003593 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3594 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3595 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003596
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003597 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3598 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003599
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003600 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3601 "server" keyword explanation below).
3602
3603server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003604 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003605 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
3606 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port>
3607 parameters must not be present; these parameters must be provided on a "bind"
3608 line (see "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003609
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003610 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3611 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3612 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3613 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3614 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003615
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003616 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003617 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003618 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003619 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3620 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3621 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003622
3623 backend mybackend
3624 mode tcp
3625 balance roundrobin
3626 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3627 stick on src
3628
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003629 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3630 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003631
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003632 Example:
3633 peers mypeers
Emeric Brune77984f2022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003634 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3635 default-server ssl verify none
3636 server haproxy1 #local peer
3637 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3638 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003639
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +02003640shards <shards>
3641
3642 In some configurations, one would like to distribute the stick-table contents
3643 to some peers in place of sending all the stick-table contents to each peer
3644 declared in the "peers" section. In such cases, "shards" specifies the
3645 number of peer involved in this stick-table contents distribution.
3646 See also "shard" server parameter.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003647
3648table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3649 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3650
3651 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3652 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003653 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003654 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3655 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3656 "stick-table" keyword).
3657
3658 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3659 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3660 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3661 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3662 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3663 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3664 of the stick-table name as follows:
3665
3666 peers mypeers
3667 peer A ...
3668 peer B ...
3669 table t1 ...
3670
3671 frontend fe1
3672 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3673
3674 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3675 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3676
3677 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3678 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3679 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3680 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3681 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3682 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3683 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3684
3685 peers mypeers
3686 peer A ...
3687 peer B ...
3688 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3689
3690 backend t1
3691 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3692
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003693 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003694 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3695 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3696
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090036973.6. Mailers
3698------------
3699It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3700If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3701in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3702
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003703mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003704 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3705 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3706
3707mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3708 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3709
3710 Example:
3711 mailers mymailers
3712 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3713 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3714
3715 backend mybackend
3716 mode tcp
3717 balance roundrobin
3718
3719 email-alert mailers mymailers
3720 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3721 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3722
3723 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3724 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3725
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003726timeout mail <time>
3727 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3728 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3729 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3730 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3731
3732 Example:
3733 mailers mymailers
3734 timeout mail 20s
3735 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003736
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020037373.7. Programs
3738-------------
3739In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3740master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3741managed the same way as the workers.
3742
3743During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3744sequence as a worker:
3745
3746 - the master is re-executed
3747 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3748 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3749 instance of the program
3750
3751During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3752
3753program <name>
3754 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3755 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3756 the management guide).
3757
3758command <command> [arguments*]
3759 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3760 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3761 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3762 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3763
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003764user <user name>
3765 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3766 See also "group".
3767
3768group <group name>
3769 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3770 See also "user".
3771
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003772option start-on-reload
3773no option start-on-reload
3774 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3775 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3776 program section.
3777
3778
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010037793.8. HTTP-errors
3780----------------
3781
3782It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3783imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3784several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3785
3786http-errors <name>
3787 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3788 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3789
3790errorfile <code> <file>
3791 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3792
3793 Arguments :
3794 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003795 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003796 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003797
3798 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3799 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3800 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3801 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3802 before any chroot is performed.
3803
3804 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3805
3806 Example:
3807 http-errors website-1
3808 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3809 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3810 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3811
3812 http-errors website-2
3813 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3814 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3815 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3816
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020038173.9. Rings
3818----------
3819
3820It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3821servers or traces.
3822
3823ring <ringname>
3824 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3825
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02003826backing-file <path>
3827 This replaces the regular memory allocation by a RAM-mapped file to store the
3828 ring. This can be useful for collecting traces or logs for post-mortem
3829 analysis, without having to attach a slow client to the CLI. Newer contents
3830 will automatically replace older ones so that the latest contents are always
3831 available. The contents written to the ring will be visible in that file once
3832 the process stops (most often they will even be seen very soon after but
3833 there is no such guarantee since writes are not synchronous).
3834
3835 When this option is used, the total storage area is reduced by the size of
3836 the "struct ring" that starts at the beginning of the area, and that is
3837 required to recover the area's contents. The file will be created with the
3838 starting user's ownership, with mode 0600 and will be of the size configured
Willy Tarreau32872db2022-08-31 18:52:17 +02003839 by the "size" directive. When the directive is parsed (thus even during
3840 config checks), any existing non-empty file will first be renamed with the
3841 extra suffix ".bak", and any previously existing file with suffix ".bak" will
3842 be removed. This ensures that instant reload or restart of the process will
3843 not wipe precious debugging information, and will leave time for an admin to
3844 spot this new ".bak" file and to archive it if needed. As such, after a crash
3845 the file designated by <path> will contain the freshest information, and if
3846 the service is restarted, the "<path>.bak" file will have it instead. This
3847 means that the total storage capacity required will be double of the ring
3848 size. Failures to rotate the file are silently ignored, so placing the file
3849 into a directory without write permissions will be sufficient to avoid the
3850 backup file if not desired.
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02003851
3852 WARNING: there are stability and security implications in using this feature.
3853 First, backing the ring to a slow device (e.g. physical hard drive) may cause
3854 perceptible slowdowns during accesses, and possibly even panics if too many
3855 threads compete for accesses. Second, an external process modifying the area
3856 could cause the haproxy process to crash or to overwrite some of its own
3857 memory with traces. Third, if the file system fills up before the ring,
3858 writes to the ring may cause the process to crash.
3859
3860 The information present in this ring are structured and are NOT directly
3861 readable using a text editor (even though most of it looks barely readable).
3862 The output of this file is only intended for developers.
3863
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003864description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003865 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003866 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3867
3868format <format>
3869 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3870
3871 Arguments:
3872 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3873 one of the following :
3874
3875 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3876 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3877 designed to be used with a local log server.
3878
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003879 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3880 field is stripped. This is the default.
3881 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3882 rfc3164.
3883
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003884 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3885 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3886 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3887 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3888 is the default.
3889
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003890 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003891 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3892
3893 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3894 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3895
3896 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3897 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3898 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3899 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3900 logger consumes.
3901
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003902 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3903 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3904 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3905 with a local log server.
3906
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003907 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3908 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3909 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3910 used with a local log server.
3911
3912maxlen <length>
3913 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3914 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3915 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3916
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003917server <name> <address> [param*]
3918 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3919 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3920 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3921 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3922 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3923 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3924 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3925 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3926 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003927 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3928 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003929
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003930size <size>
3931 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3932 set to BUFSIZE.
3933
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003934timeout connect <timeout>
3935 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3936
3937 Arguments :
3938 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3939 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3940 as explained at the top of this document.
3941
3942timeout server <timeout>
3943 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3944
3945 Arguments :
3946 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3947 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3948 as explained at the top of this document.
3949
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003950 Example:
3951 global
3952 log ring@myring local7
3953
3954 ring myring
3955 description "My local buffer"
3956 format rfc3164
3957 maxlen 1200
3958 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003959 timeout connect 5s
3960 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003961 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003962
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020039633.10. Log forwarding
3964-------------------
3965
3966It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003967HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003968
3969log-forward <name>
3970 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3971
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003972backlog <conns>
3973 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3974 on connections accept.
3975
3976bind <addr> [param*]
3977 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003978 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3979 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3980 syslog protocol over TCP.
3981 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003982 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3983
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003984dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003985 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3986 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3987 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3988 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003989 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003990
3991log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003992log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003993 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3994 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3995 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003996 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003997 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3998 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3999 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004000 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004001
4002 Example:
4003 global
4004 log stderr format iso local7
4005
4006 ring myring
4007 description "My local buffer"
4008 format rfc5424
4009 maxlen 1200
4010 size 32764
4011 timeout connect 5s
4012 timeout server 10s
4013 # syslog tcp server
4014 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
4015
4016 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004017 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
4018 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004019 # all messages on stderr
4020 log global
4021 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
4022 log ring@myring local0
4023 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
4024 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
4025 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
4026 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
4027 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004028
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004029maxconn <conns>
4030 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
4031 10 is the default.
4032
4033timeout client <timeout>
4034 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
4035
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020040364. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004037----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004038
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004039Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004040 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
4041 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4042 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4043 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004044
4045A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
4046connections.
4047
4048A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
4049to forward incoming connections.
4050
4051A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
4052parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
4053
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004054A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
4055ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
4056sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
4057the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
4058explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
4059from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
4060"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
4061for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
4062to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
4063optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
4064are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
4065any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
4066names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
4067that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
4068duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02004069names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
4070is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
4071implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
4072encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
4073adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004074
4075Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
4076settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
4077of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
4078profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
4079timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
4080
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004081All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
4082'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
4083case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
4084
4085Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
4086logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
4087proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
4088However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
4089name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
4090
4091Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
4092and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004093bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004094protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
4095modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
4096arbitrary criteria.
4097
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004098In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
4099a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01004100the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004101
4102 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
4103 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
4104 between responses and new requests.
4105
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004106 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
4107 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
4108 client-facing connection remains open.
4109
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004110 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
4111 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004112
4113The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
4114frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
4115following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004116weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004117
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004118 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004119
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004120 | KAL | SCL | CLO
4121 ----+-----+-----+----
4122 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
4123 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004124 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
4125 ----+-----+-----+----
4126 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004127
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004128It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004129only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
4130within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004131as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004132content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004133and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
4134possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004135
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004136There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004137first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004138processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004139second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004140protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
4141is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
4142new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004143to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004144process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
4145already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
4146HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
4147evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
4148one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
4149
4150There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
4151performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
4152tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
4153preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
4154analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
4155HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
4156header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
4157mitigate this drawback.
4158
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004159There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004160method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
4161set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
4162in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
4163is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
4164to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
4165above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
4166to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
4167"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
4168frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
4169frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
4170as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
4171upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
4172on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
4173the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
4174upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
4175frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
4176remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020041784.1. Proxy keywords matrix
4179--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004181The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
4182limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
4183they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
4184limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004185marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004186option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02004187and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
4188with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004189specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
4190sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
4191anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004192
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004193
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004194 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
4195------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004196acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004197backlog X X X -
4198balance X - X X
4199bind - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004200capture cookie - X X -
4201capture request header - X X -
4202capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004203clitcpka-cnt X X X -
4204clitcpka-idle X X X -
4205clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004206compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004207cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004208declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004209default-server X - X X
4210default_backend X X X -
4211description - X X X
4212disabled X X X X
4213dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004214email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004215email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004216email-alert mailers X X X X
4217email-alert myhostname X X X X
4218email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004219enabled X X X X
4220errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004221errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004222errorloc X X X X
4223errorloc302 X X X X
4224-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4225errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02004226error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004227force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004228filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004229fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004230hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004231http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004232http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004233http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004234http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004235http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02004236http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02004237http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004238http-check set-var X - X X
4239http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004240http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004241http-request X (!) X X X
4242http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004243http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGONdf238c32023-01-12 15:59:27 +01004244http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004245id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004246ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004247load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004248log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004249log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004250log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004251log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004252max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004253maxconn X X X -
4254mode X X X X
4255monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004256monitor-uri X X X -
4257option abortonclose (*) X - X X
4258option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
4259option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
4260option allbackups (*) X - X X
4261option checkcache (*) X - X X
4262option clitcpka (*) X X X -
4263option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02004264option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004265option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
4266option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004267-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4268option forwardfor X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01004269option forwarded (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02004270option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
4271option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004272option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02004273option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004274option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004275option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02004276option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02004277option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004278option http-server-close (*) X X X X
4279option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
4280option httpchk X - X X
4281option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01004282option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02004283option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004284option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004285option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004286option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004287option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
4288option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
4289option logasap (*) X X X -
4290option mysql-check X - X X
4291option nolinger (*) X X X X
4292option originalto X X X X
4293option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02004294option pgsql-check X - X X
4295option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004296option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004297option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004298option smtpchk X - X X
4299option socket-stats (*) X X X -
4300option splice-auto (*) X X X X
4301option splice-request (*) X X X X
4302option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +01004303option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004304option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
4305option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
4306-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004307option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004308option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
4309option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
4310option tcpka X X X X
4311option tcplog X X X X
4312option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01004313option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004314external-check command X - X X
4315external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004316persist rdp-cookie X - X X
4317rate-limit sessions X X X -
4318redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004319-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004320retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02004321retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004322server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004323server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02004324server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004325source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004326srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
4327srvtcpka-idle X - X X
4328srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02004329stats admin - X X X
4330stats auth X X X X
4331stats enable X X X X
4332stats hide-version X X X X
4333stats http-request - X X X
4334stats realm X X X X
4335stats refresh X X X X
4336stats scope X X X X
4337stats show-desc X X X X
4338stats show-legends X X X X
4339stats show-node X X X X
4340stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004341-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4342stick match - - X X
4343stick on - - X X
4344stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02004345stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01004346stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004347tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004348tcp-check connect X - X X
4349tcp-check expect X - X X
4350tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004351tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004352tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004353tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004354tcp-check set-var X - X X
4355tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004356tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
4357tcp-request content X (!) X X X
4358tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
4359tcp-request session X (!) X X -
4360tcp-response content X (!) - X X
4361tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004362timeout check X - X X
4363timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004364timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004365timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004366timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
4367timeout http-request X X X X
4368timeout queue X - X X
4369timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004370timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004371timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004372timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004373transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01004374unique-id-format X X X -
4375unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004376use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02004377use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02004378use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004379------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
4380 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004381
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020043834.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
4384---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004385
4386This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
4387
4388
4389acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
4390 Declare or complete an access list.
4391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004392 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
4393
4394 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
4395 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
4396 using it.
4397
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004398 Example:
4399 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
4400 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
4401 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
4402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004403 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004404
4405
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004406backlog <conns>
4407 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4409 yes | yes | yes | no
4410 Arguments :
4411 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
4412 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004413 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004414
4415 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
4416 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
4417 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
4418 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
4419 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
4420 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
4421 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
4422 backlog parameter.
4423
4424 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
4425 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4426 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4427
4428 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4429
4430
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004431balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004432balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004433 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4435 yes | no | yes | yes
4436 Arguments :
4437 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4438 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4439 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4440 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4441
4442 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4443 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4444 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4445 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004446 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004447 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004448 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4449 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4450 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4451 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4452 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4453 it, so that you don't worry.
4454
4455 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4456 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4457 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4458 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4459 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4460 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4461 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4462 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004463
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004464 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4465 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4466 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4467 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4468 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4469 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4470 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004471 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4472 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4473 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004474
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004475 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004476 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004477 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4478 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004479 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004480 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4481 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4482 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4483 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4484 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004485 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4486 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4487 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4488 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4489 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4490 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004491
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004492 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4493 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4494 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4495 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4496 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4497 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4498 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4499 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4500 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4501 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4502 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4503 changed using "hash-type".
4504
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004505 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4506 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4507 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4508 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4509 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4510 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4511 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4512 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004513 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004514 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004515 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4516 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004517 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004518
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004519 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4520 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4521 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4522 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4523 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4524 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4525 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4526 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4527 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4528 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4529 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4530 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004531
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004532 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004533 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4534 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4535 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4536 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4537 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4538 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4539 URIs start with a leading "/".
4540
4541 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4542 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4543 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4544 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4545
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004546 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4547 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4548 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004549 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4550 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004551
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004552 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004553 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4554
4555 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004556 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4557 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004558 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4559 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4560 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4561 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004562 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004563 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4564 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004565
4566 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4567 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4568 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4569 server will receive the request.
4570
4571 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4572 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4573 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4574 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4575 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004576 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4577 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004578 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4579 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004580
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004581 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4582 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4583 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4584 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4585 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004586
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004587 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004588 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4589 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4590 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4591
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004592 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4593 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004594 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4595 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004596
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004597 random
4598 random(<draws>)
4599 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004600 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4601 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4602 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4603 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004604 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4605 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4606 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4607 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4608 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4609 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4610 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4611 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4612 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4613 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4614 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4615 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4616 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4617 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4618 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4619 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4620 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4621 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4622 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4623 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004624
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004625 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004626 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004627 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4628 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004629 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004630 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4631 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4632 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004633 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004634 used instead.
4635
4636 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4637 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4638 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004639 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004640
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004641 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4642 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004643 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4644 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004645
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004646 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004647 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4648 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004649
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004650 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4651 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4652 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004653
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004654 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004655 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004656 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4657 NTLM relies on.
4658
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004659 Examples :
4660 balance roundrobin
4661 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004662 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004663 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4664 balance hdr(host)
4665 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004666 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
4667 balance hash var(req.client_id)
4668 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004669
4670 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4671 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4672
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004673 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004674 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4675 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4676 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004677 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004678
4679 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4680 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4681 defaults to 16 kB.
4682
4683 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4684 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4685
4686 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4687 Round Robin.
4688
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004689 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004690 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4691 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4692 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4693
4694 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4695
4696 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004697 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004698 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4699 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4700 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004701
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004702 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004703
4704
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004705bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4706bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004707 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4709 no | yes | yes | no
4710 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004711 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4712 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4713 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4714 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004715 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'. Note
4716 that if you bind a frontend to multiple UDP addresses you have
4717 no guarantee about the address which will be used to respond.
4718 This is why "0.0.0.0" addresses and lists of comma-separated
4719 IP addresses have been forbidden to bind QUIC addresses.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004720 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4721 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4722 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4723 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4724 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4725 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004726 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004727 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4728 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004729 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004730 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4731 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004732 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004733 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4734 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004735 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004736 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004737 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4738 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4739 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004740 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4741 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4742 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4743 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004744 - 'quic4@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01004745 is used. Note that to achieve the best performance with a
4746 large traffic you should keep "tune.quic.conn-owner" on
4747 connection. Else QUIC connections will be multiplexed
4748 over the listener socket. Another alternative would be to
4749 duplicate QUIC listener instances over several threads,
4750 for example using "shards" keyword to at least reduce
4751 thread contention.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004752 - 'quic6@' -> address is resolved as IPv6 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyelle7078fb12022-11-22 11:26:16 +01004753 is used. The performance note for QUIC over IPv4 applies
4754 as well.
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004755
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004756 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4757 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4758 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004759
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004760 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4761 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004762 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4763 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4764 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004765 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4766 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4767 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4768 the range.
4769
4770 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4771 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4772 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4773 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4774 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4775 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4776 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004777 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004778 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004779
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004780 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004781 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004782 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4783 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4784 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4785 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4786 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4787 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4788
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004789 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4790 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4791 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4792 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004793
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004794 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4795 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4796 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4797 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4798 in a frontend.
4799
4800 Example :
4801 listen http_proxy
4802 bind :80,:443
4803 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004804 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004805
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004806 listen http_https_proxy
4807 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004808 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004809
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004810 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4811 bind ipv6@:80
4812 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4813 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4814
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004815 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004816 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004817
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004818 listen h3_quic_proxy
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004819 bind quic4@10.0.0.1:8888 ssl crt /etc/mycrt alpn h3
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004820
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004821 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4822 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4823 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4824 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4825 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4826
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004827 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004828 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004829
4830
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004831capture cookie <name> len <length>
4832 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4834 no | yes | yes | no
4835 Arguments :
4836 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4837 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4838 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4839 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004840 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004841
4842 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4843 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4844 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4845 right if it exceeds <length>.
4846
4847 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4848 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4849 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4850 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4851
4852 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4853 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4854 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4855
4856 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4857 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4858 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004859 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4860 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4861 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004862
4863 Example:
4864 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4865
4866 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004867 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004868
4869
4870capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004871 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4873 no | yes | yes | no
4874 Arguments :
4875 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004876 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004877 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4878 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4879 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4880
4881 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4882 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4883 it exceeds <length>.
4884
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004885 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004886 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4887 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004888 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4889 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4890 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4891 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004892 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004893 environments to find where the request came from.
4894
4895 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4896 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4897 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4898 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004899
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004900 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4901 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4902 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4903 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4904 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004905
4906 Example:
4907 capture request header Host len 15
4908 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004909 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004911 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004912 about logging.
4913
4914
4915capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004916 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4918 no | yes | yes | no
4919 Arguments :
4920 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004921 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004922 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4923 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4924 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4925
4926 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4927 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4928 it exceeds <length>.
4929
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004930 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004931 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4932 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4933 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004934 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4935 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4936 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4937 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004938
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004939 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4940 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4941 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4942 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4943 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004944
4945 Example:
4946 capture response header Content-length len 9
4947 capture response header Location len 15
4948
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004949 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004950 about logging.
4951
4952
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004953clitcpka-cnt <count>
4954 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4955 the connection on the client side.
4956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4957 yes | yes | yes | no
4958 Arguments :
4959 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4960
4961 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4962 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004963 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4964 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004965
4966 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4967
4968
4969clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4970 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4971 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4972 client side.
4973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4974 yes | yes | yes | no
4975 Arguments :
4976 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4977 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4978 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4979 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4980
4981 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4982 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004983 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4984 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004985
4986 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4987
4988
4989clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4990 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4992 yes | yes | yes | no
4993 Arguments :
4994 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4995 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4996 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4997 document.
4998
4999 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
5000 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005001 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5002 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005003
5004 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
5005
5006
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005007compression algo <algorithm> ...
5008compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005009 Enable HTTP compression.
5010 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5011 yes | yes | yes | yes
5012 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005013 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
5014 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005015
5016 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005017 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
5018 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
5019 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005020
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005021 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005022 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005023
5024 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
5025 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
5026 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
5027 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
5028 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005029 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005030
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005031 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
5032 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
5033 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
5034 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
5035 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
5036 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
5037 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005038 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005039
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04005040 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005041 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005042 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005043 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005044 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005045 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005046 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02005047
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005048 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005049 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
5050 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02005051 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005052 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005053 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
5054 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
5055 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
5056 "multipart"
5057 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
5058 header
5059 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
5060 and later
5061 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
5062 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005063 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005064
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01005065 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005066
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005067 Examples :
5068 compression algo gzip
5069 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005070
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01005071 See also : "compression offload"
5072
5073compression offload
5074 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
5075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5076 no | yes | yes | yes
5077
5078 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
5079 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
5080 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
5081 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
5082 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
5083 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
5084 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
5085 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
5086 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
5087 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
5088 then be used for such scenarios.
5089
5090 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
5091 option is ignored.
5092
5093 See also : "compression type", "compression algo"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005094
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005095cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005096 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
5097 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005098 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005099 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
5100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5101 yes | no | yes | yes
5102 Arguments :
5103 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
5104 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
5105 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
5106 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
5107 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
5108 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005109 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005110 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
5111 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
5112
5113 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005114 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005115 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
5116 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
5117 headers is left to the application. The application can then
5118 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005119 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
5120 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005121 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005122 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
5123 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005124
5125 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005126 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005127
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005128 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005129 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005130 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005131 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005132 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
5133 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
5134 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
5135 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
5136 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
5137 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
5138 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005139
5140 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
5141 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
5142 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
5143 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
5144 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
5145 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
5146 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
5147 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
5148 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005149 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005150 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
5151 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
5152 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005153
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005154 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
5155 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
5156 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005157 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
5158 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
5159 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
5160 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005161 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
5162 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
5163 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005164
5165 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
5166 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
5167 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
5168 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
5169 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
5170 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
5171 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
5172 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
5173 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
5174
5175 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
5176 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
5177 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
5178 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
5179 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
5180 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
5181 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
5182 persistence cookie in the cache.
5183 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
5184
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005185 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
5186 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005187 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005188 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
5189 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005190 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005191 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
5192 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
5193 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
5194 they logout.
5195
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005196 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005197 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
5198 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
5199 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
5200
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005201 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005202 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
5203 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
5204 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
5205 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
5206 this attribute.
5207
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005208 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005209 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01005210 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
5211 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
5212 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
5213 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
5214 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
5215 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005216
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005217 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
5218 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
5219 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
5220 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
5221 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
5222 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
5223 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
5224 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005225 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005226 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
5227 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
5228 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
5229 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
5230 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
5231 the site.
5232
5233 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
5234 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
5235 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
5236 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
5237 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
5238 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
5239 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
5240 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
5241 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
5242 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
5243 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
5244 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
5245 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005246 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005247 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
5248 redispatch after some absolute delay.
5249
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005250 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
5251 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
5252 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
5253 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
5254 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
5255 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
5256
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005257 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005258 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
5259 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
5260 repeated.
5261
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005262 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
5263 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
5264 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
5265 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005266
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005267 Examples :
5268 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
5269 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5270 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005271 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005272
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02005273 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005274
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005275
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005276declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
5277 Declares a capture slot.
5278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5279 no | yes | yes | no
5280 Arguments:
5281 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
5282
5283 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
5284 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
5285 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
5286 for use in the response.
5287
5288 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02005289 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005290 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
5291
5292
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005293default-server [param*]
5294 Change default options for a server in a backend
5295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5296 yes | no | yes | yes
5297 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005298 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
5299 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
5300 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
5301 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005302
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005303 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005304 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
5305
5306 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005307
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005308
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005309default_backend <backend>
5310 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
5311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5312 yes | yes | yes | no
5313 Arguments :
5314 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
5315
5316 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
5317 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
5318 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
5319 will catch all undetermined requests.
5320
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005321 Example :
5322
5323 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
5324 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
5325 default_backend dynamic
5326
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02005327 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005328
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005329
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02005330description <string>
5331 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
5332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5333 no | yes | yes | yes
5334 Arguments : string
5335
5336 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
5337 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
5338 it describes.
5339 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
5340
5341
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005342disabled
5343 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5345 yes | yes | yes | yes
5346 Arguments : none
5347
5348 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
5349 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
5350 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
5351 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
5352 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
5353 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
5354 keyword in a "defaults" section.
5355
5356 See also : "enabled"
5357
5358
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005359dispatch <address>:<port>
5360 Set a default server address
5361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5362 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005363 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005364
5365 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
5366 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5367 during start-up.
5368
5369 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
5370 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
5371 possible with normal servers.
5372
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02005373 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005374 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
5375 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
5376 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
5377 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
5378
5379 See also : "server"
5380
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005381
5382dynamic-cookie-key <string>
5383 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
5384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5385 yes | no | yes | yes
5386 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
5387
5388 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005389 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005390 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
5391 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005392 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005393 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005394
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005395enabled
5396 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5398 yes | yes | yes | yes
5399 Arguments : none
5400
5401 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
5402 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
5403
5404 See also : "disabled"
5405
5406
5407errorfile <code> <file>
5408 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5410 yes | yes | yes | yes
5411 Arguments :
5412 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005413 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005414 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005415
5416 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005417 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005418 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005419 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
5420 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005421
5422 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5423 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5424 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5425
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005426 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5427
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02005428 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
5429 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
5430 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5431 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5432 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5433 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5434 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5435 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5436 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005437
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005438 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5439 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5440 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005441 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005442 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5443
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005444 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005445
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005446 Example :
5447 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005448 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005449 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5450 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5451
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005452
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005453errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5454 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5455 section.
5456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5457 yes | yes | yes | yes
5458 Arguments :
5459 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5460
5461 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005462 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005463 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5464 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005465
5466 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5467 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5468 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5469 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5470 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005471 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005472 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5473
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005474 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5475 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005476
5477 Example :
5478 errorfiles generic
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01005479 errorfiles site-1 403 404
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005480
5481
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005482errorloc <code> <url>
5483errorloc302 <code> <url>
5484 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5485 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5486 yes | yes | yes | yes
5487 Arguments :
5488 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005489 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005490 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005491
5492 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5493 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5494 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5495 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005496 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005497
5498 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5499 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5500 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5501
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005502 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5503
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005504 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5505 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5506 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5507 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005508 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005509 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5510 request.
5511
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005512 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005513
5514
5515errorloc303 <code> <url>
5516 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5518 yes | yes | yes | yes
5519 Arguments :
5520 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005521 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005522 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005523
5524 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5525 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5526 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5527 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005528 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005529
5530 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5531 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5532 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5533
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005534 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5535
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005536 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5537 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5538 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5539 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005540 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005541
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005542 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005543
5544
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005545email-alert from <emailaddr>
5546 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005547 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005548 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5549 yes | yes | yes | yes
5550
5551 Arguments :
5552
5553 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5554
5555 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5556 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5557
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005558 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005559 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5560 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005561
5562
5563email-alert level <level>
5564 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5565 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5566 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5567 yes | yes | yes | yes
5568
5569 Arguments :
5570
5571 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5572 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5573 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5574
5575 By default level is alert
5576
5577 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5578 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5579 for the proxy.
5580
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005581 Alerts are sent when :
5582
5583 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5584 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5585 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5586 is notice or lower
5587 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5588 and a health check status update occurs
5589
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005590 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5591 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005592 section 3.6 about mailers.
5593
5594
5595email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5596 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5597 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5598 yes | yes | yes | yes
5599
5600 Arguments :
5601
5602 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5603
5604 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5605 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5606
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005607 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5608 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005609
5610
5611email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5612 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5613 mailers.
5614 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5615 yes | yes | yes | yes
5616
5617 Arguments :
5618
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005619 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005620
5621 By default the systems hostname is used.
5622
5623 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5624 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5625 for the proxy.
5626
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005627 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5628 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005629
5630
5631email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005632 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005633 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5634 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5635 yes | yes | yes | yes
5636
5637 Arguments :
5638
5639 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5640
5641 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5642 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5643
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005644 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005645 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5646
5647
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005648error-log-format <string>
5649 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5650 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5651 yes | yes | yes | no
5652
5653 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5654 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5655 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5656 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005657 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5658
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005659 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5660 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5661 string in depth.
5662
5663 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5664 directives.
5665
5666
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005667force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5668 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5669 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005670 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005671
5672 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5673 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5674 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5675 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5676 marked down for maintenance operations.
5677
5678 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5679 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5680 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5681 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5682 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5683 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5684 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5685 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5686 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5687
5688 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5689 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5690 is used.
5691
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005692 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005693 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005694
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005695
5696filter <name> [param*]
5697 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5699 no | yes | yes | yes
5700 Arguments :
5701 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5702 referenced in section 9.
5703
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005704 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005705 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005706 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5707 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005708
5709 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5710 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5711
5712 Example:
5713 listen
5714 bind *:80
5715
5716 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5717 filter compression
5718 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5719
5720 compression algo gzip
5721 compression offload
5722
5723 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5724
5725 See also : section 9.
5726
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005727
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005728fullconn <conns>
5729 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5731 yes | no | yes | yes
5732 Arguments :
5733 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5734 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5735
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005736 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005737 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005738 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005739 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5740 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5741 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5742 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5743 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005744 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005745
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005746 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005747 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005748 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5749 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5750 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005751
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005752 Example :
5753 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5754 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5755 # connections.
5756 backend dynamic
5757 fullconn 10000
5758 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5759 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5760
5761 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5762
5763
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005764hash-balance-factor <factor>
5765 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5767 yes | no | no | yes
5768 Arguments :
5769 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5770 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005771 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005772
5773 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5774 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5775 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5776 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5777 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5778 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5779 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5780
5781 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5782 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5783 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5784 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5785 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5786
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005787 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5788 consistent hashing mechanism.
5789
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005790 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5791
5792
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005793hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005794 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5796 yes | no | yes | yes
5797 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005798 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5799 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005800
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005801 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5802 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5803 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5804 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5805 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5806 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5807 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5808 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5809 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5810 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005811
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005812 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5813 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5814 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5815 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5816 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5817 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5818 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5819 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5820 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5821 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5822 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5823 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5824 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005825 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5826 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005827
5828 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5829
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005830 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005831 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5832 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5833 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005834 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5835 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5836 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005837
5838 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5839 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005840 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5841 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5842 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5843 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5844
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005845 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005846 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5847 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5848 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5849 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5850 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5851 parameter.
5852
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005853 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5854 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5855 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5856 used on strings.
5857
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005858 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5859
5860 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5861 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5862 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5863 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5864 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5865 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5866 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5867 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5868 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5869 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5870 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5871 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005872
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005873 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5874 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5875 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005876
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005877 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005878
5879
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005880http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5881 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5882 ones).
5883
5884 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005885 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005886
5887 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5888 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5889 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5890 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5891 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5892 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5893
5894 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5895 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5896 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5897
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005898 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
5899 supported:
5900 - add-header <name> <fmt>
5901 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005902 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005903 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005904 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005905 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005906 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5907 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01005908 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005909 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
5910 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
5911 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
5912 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5913 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005914 - set-header <name> <fmt>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005915 - set-log-level <level>
5916 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005917 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005918 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
5919 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005920 - strict-mode { on | off }
5921 - unset-var(<var-name>)
5922
5923 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005924
5925 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5926 instance.
5927
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005928 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
5929 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
5930 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
5931 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
5932 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
5933 a defaults section defining such rules.
5934
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005935 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5936 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5937 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5938
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005939 Example:
5940 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5941 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5942 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5943
5944http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5945
5946 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005947 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
5948 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005949
Christopher Fauletd9d36b82023-01-05 10:25:30 +01005950http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5951
5952 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5953 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
5954
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005955http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5956
5957 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5958 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
5959 complete description.
5960
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005961http-after-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5962
5963 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
5964 del-acl" for a complete description.
5965
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005966http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005967
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005968 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
5969 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005970
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005971http-after-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5972
5973 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
5974 del-map" for a complete description.
5975
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005976http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5977 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5978
5979 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5980
5981 Example:
5982 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5983
5984 # applied to:
5985 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5986
5987 # outputs:
5988 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5989
5990 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5991
5992http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5993 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5994
5995 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5996
5997 Example:
5998 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5999
6000 # applied to:
6001 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
6002
6003 # outputs:
6004 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
6005
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006006http-after-response sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6007 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6008
6009 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
6010 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
6011 a complete description.
6012
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006013http-after-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6014http-after-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6015http-after-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6016
6017 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
6018 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
6019 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
6020 description.
6021
6022http-after-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6023 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6024http-after-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6025 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6026
6027 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
6028 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
6029 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
6030
6031http-after-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6032
6033 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
6034 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
6035
6036http-after-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6037
6038 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
6039 set-map" for a complete description.
6040
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006041http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6042
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006043 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
6044 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6045 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6046 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006047
6048http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6049 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6050
6051 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05006052 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006053 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006054
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006055http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6056http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006057
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006058 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6059 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
6060 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006061
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006062http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006063
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006064 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
6065 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006066
6067http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6068
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006069 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
6070 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006071
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006072
6073http-check comment <string>
6074 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
6075 it fails.
6076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6077 yes | no | yes | yes
6078
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006079 Arguments :
6080 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
6081 rule fails.
6082
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006083 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
6084 user-friendly error reporting.
6085
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006086 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006087 "http-check expect".
6088
6089
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006090http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
6091 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01006092 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006093 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
6094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6095 yes | no | yes | yes
6096
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006097 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006098 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6099
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006100 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006101 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006102
6103 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
6104 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6105 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
6106 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
6107
6108 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
6109
6110 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6111
6112 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
6113
6114 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6115
6116 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
6117
6118 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
6119 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
6120 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
6121 is used.
6122
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02006123 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
6124 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
6125 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
6126 haproxy -vv.
6127
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006128 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
6129
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006130 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
6131 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
6132 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
6133 different ports or with different servers.
6134
6135 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6136 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
6137 the port with a "http-check connect".
6138
6139 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6140 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6141 do.
6142
6143 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
6144 unset-var or comment rules.
6145
6146 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006147 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6148 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6149 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6150 option httpchk
6151
6152 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006153 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006154 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006155 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006156 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006157 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006158
6159 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6160
6161 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006162
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006163
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006164http-check disable-on-404
6165 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
6166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006167 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006168 Arguments : none
6169
6170 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
6171 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
6172 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
6173 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
6174 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
6175 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
6176 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
6177 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006178 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
6179 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01006180 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
6181 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
6182 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006183
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006184 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006185
6186
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006187http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006188 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
6189 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
6190 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006191 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02006193 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006194
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006195 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006196 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6197
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006198 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
6199 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
6200 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
6201 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
6202 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
6203 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
6204 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
6205 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
6206 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
6207 result is always conclusive.
6208
6209 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6210 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
6211 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006212 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
6213 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006214 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6215 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006216 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
6217 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
6218 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006219
6220 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6221 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006222 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
6223 supported :
6224 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6225 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006226 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
6227 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
6228 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
6229 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
6230 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006231
6232 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6233 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006234 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
6235 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
6236 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
6237 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006238 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
6239
6240 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6241 informational message reported in logs if the expect
6242 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
6243 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
6244
6245 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6246 informational message reported in logs if an error
6247 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
6248 log-format string.
6249
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006250 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006251 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
6252 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006253 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
6254 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
6255 details on the supported keywords.
6256
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006257 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
6258 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
6259 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
6260 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006261
6262 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
6263 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
6264 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
6265 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
6266 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
6267
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006268 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
6269 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
6270 codes. A health check response will be considered as
6271 valid if the response's status code matches any status
6272 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
6273 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6274 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006275
6276 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006277 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006278 response's status code matches the expression. If the
6279 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6280 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
6281 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
6282
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006283 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6284 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006285 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
6286 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
6287 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
6288 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
6289 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
6290 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
6291 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
6292 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006293 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
6294 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
6295 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
6296 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
6297 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
6298 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
6299 insensitive on the header names.
6300
6301 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6302 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
6303 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
6304 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
6305 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
6306 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006307
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006308 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006309 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006310 response's body contains this exact string. If the
6311 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6312 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
6313 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
6314 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006315 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006316 trace).
6317
6318 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006319 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006320 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
6321 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6322 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
6323 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
6324 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006325 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006326
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02006327 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
6328 A health check response will be considered valid if the
6329 response's body contains the string resulting of the
6330 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
6331 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6332 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
6333
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006334 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01006335 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006336 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
6337 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
6338 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
6339 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
6340 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
6341 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
6342
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006343 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
6344 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
6345 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
6346 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
6347 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01006348
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006349 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
6350 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
6351
6352 Examples :
6353 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006354 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006355
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006356 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
6357 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
6358
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006359 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006360 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006361
6362 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006363 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006364
6365 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006366 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006367
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006368 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006369 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006370
6371
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006372http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006373 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
6374 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006375 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
6376 health checks.
6377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6378 yes | no | yes | yes
6379 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006380 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6381
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006382 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
6383 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
6384 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
6385 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
6386 to invent non-standard ones.
6387
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006388 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6389 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
6390 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
6391 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6392
6393 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6394 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
6395 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6396 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006397
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02006398 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006399 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006400 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006401 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
6402 to add it.
6403
6404 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
6405 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
6406 to the log-format rules.
6407
6408 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
6409 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
6410 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006411
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006412 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
6413 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
6414 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
6415 request.
6416
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006417 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
6418 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
6419 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006420 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
6421 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
6422 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
6423 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006424 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006425
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006426 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006427 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
6428 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006429
6430 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
6431 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
6432 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
6433 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
6434 configured request authority.
6435
6436 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
6437 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006438
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006439 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006440
6441
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006442http-check send-state
6443 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
6444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6445 yes | no | yes | yes
6446 Arguments : none
6447
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006448 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006449 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006450 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
6451 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
6452 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006453
6454 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
6455 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
6456 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
6457 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
6458 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08006459 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
6460 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
6461 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6462
6463 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
6464 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
6465 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6466
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006467 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
6468 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
6469 checked in multiple backends.
6470
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006471 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006472 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
6473
6474 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
6475 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
6476 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
6477 one fails.
6478
6479 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
6480 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
6481 connections on all servers of the same backend.
6482
6483 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
6484 server's queue.
6485
6486 Example of a header received by the application server :
6487 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6488 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6489
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006490 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6491 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006492
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006493
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006494http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6495http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006496 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006497 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6498 yes | no | yes | yes
6499
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006500 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006501 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6502 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6503 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6504 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6505 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6506 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6507 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6508 and '-'.
6509
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006510 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6511 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006512 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006513 conditions.
6514
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006515 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6516
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006517 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6518 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6519
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006520 Examples :
6521 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006522 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006523
6524
6525http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006526 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006527 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6528 yes | no | yes | yes
6529
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006530 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006531 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6532 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6533 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6534 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6535 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6536 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6537 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6538 and '-'.
6539
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006540 Examples :
6541 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006542
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006543
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006544http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6545 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6546 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6547 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6548 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6550 yes | yes | yes | yes
6551 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006552 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006553 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006554 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006555 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006556
6557 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6558 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6559 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6560 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6561
6562 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6563 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6564 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6565 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6566
6567 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6568 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6569 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6570 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6571 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6572 chroot is performed.
6573
6574 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6575 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6576 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6577 considered.
6578
6579 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6580 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6581 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6582 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6583 considered as a raw string.
6584
6585 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
6586 The content-type must always be set as argument to
6587 "content-type".
6588
6589 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6590 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6591 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6592 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6593 evaluated as a log-format string.
6594
6595 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6596 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6597 argument to "content-type".
6598
6599 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6600 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6601 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
6602 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
6603
6604 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
6605 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
6606 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
6607 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
6608 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
6609 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
6610 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
6611 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
6612
6613 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
6614 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
6615 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
6616
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006617 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6618 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6619 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6620 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6621 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6622
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006623 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6624 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6625
6626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006627http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006628 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6629
6630 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006631 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006632
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006633 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6634 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6635 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6636 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6637 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006638
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006639 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6640 supported:
6641 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6642 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6643 - allow
6644 - auth [realm <realm>]
6645 - cache-use <name>
6646 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6647 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6648 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6649 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6650 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6651 - disable-l7-retry
6652 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6653 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6654 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6655 - redirect <rule>
6656 - reject
6657 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6658 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6659 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6660 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6661 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6662 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006663 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006664 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6665 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6666 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6667 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6668 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01006669 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006670 - set-dst <expr>
6671 - set-dst-port <expr>
6672 - set-header <name> <fmt>
6673 - set-log-level <level>
6674 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6675 - set-mark <mark>
6676 - set-method <fmt>
6677 - set-nice <nice>
6678 - set-path <fmt>
6679 - set-pathq <fmt>
6680 - set-priority-class <expr>
6681 - set-priority-offset <expr>
6682 - set-query <fmt>
6683 - set-src <expr>
6684 - set-src-port <expr>
6685 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
6686 - set-tos <tos>
6687 - set-uri <fmt>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006688 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6689 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006690 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01006691 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006692 - strict-mode { on | off }
6693 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6694 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
6695 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
6696 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
6697 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6698 - use-service <service-name>
6699 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6700 - wait-for-handshake
6701 - cache-use <name>
6702
6703 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006704
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006705 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006706
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006707 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6708 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6709 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6710 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6711 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6712 a defaults section defining such rules.
6713
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006714 Example:
6715 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6716 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6717 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006718
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006719 http-request allow if nagios
6720 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6721 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6722 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006723
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006724 Example:
6725 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6726 acl add path /addacl
6727 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006728
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006729 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006730
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006731 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6732 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006733
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006734 Example:
6735 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6736 acl setmap path /setmap
6737 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006738
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006739 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006740
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006741 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6742 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006743
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006744 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6745 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006746
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006747http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006748
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006749 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6750 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6751 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6752 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6753 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6754 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6755 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6756 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006757
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006758http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006759
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006760 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6761 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6762 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6763 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6764 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6765 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6766 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6767 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006769http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006771 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01006772 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006773
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006774http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006775
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006776 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6777 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6778 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6779 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6780 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006781
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006782 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6783 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6784 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6785 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6786 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6787 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6788 instead.
6789
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006790 Example:
6791 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6792 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006793
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006794http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006795
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006796 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006797
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006798http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6799 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006800
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006801 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6802 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6803 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6804 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6805 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6806 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6807 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6808 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6809 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006810
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006811 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6812 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6813 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006814 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6815
6816 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6817 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6818 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6819 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006820
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006821http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006822
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006823 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6824 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6825 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6826 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6827 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6828 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006829
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006830http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006831
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006832 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6833 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6834 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6835 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6836 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006837
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006838http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006839
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006840 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6841 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6842 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6843 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6844 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6845 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006846
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006847http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6848http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6849 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6850 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6851 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6852 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006853
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006854 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6855 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6856 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006857 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006858 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6859 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6860 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006861 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006862 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006863
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006864http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6865 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6866 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6867 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6868
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006869http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6870 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006871
6872 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6873 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6874 pointed by <resolvers>.
6875 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6876 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6877 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6878 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6879 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6880 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6881 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6882 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6883 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6884 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemand1ef24602022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006885 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6886 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006887
6888 Example:
6889 resolvers mydns
6890 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6891 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6892 timeout retry 1s
6893 hold valid 10s
6894 hold nx 3s
6895 hold other 3s
6896 hold obsolete 0s
6897 accepted_payload_size 8192
6898
6899 frontend fe
6900 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandb5c2cd42022-08-26 16:48:07 +02006901 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),host_only
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006902 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6903
6904 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6905 # which mean DNS resolution error
6906 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6907
6908 default_backend be
6909
6910 backend b_503
6911 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6912 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6913 # 503 error page to end users
6914
6915 backend be
6916 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6917 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6918 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6919 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6920 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6921
6922 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6923 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6924
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006925http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6926
6927 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6928 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6929 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6930 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006931 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6932 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006933
6934 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6935
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006936http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006937http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006938http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006939http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006940http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006941http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006942http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006943http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6944http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006945
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006946 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6947
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006948 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006949 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6950 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6951 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6952 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006953
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006954 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6955 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6956 the supported backend.
6957
6958 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6959 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6960 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6961 number of segments in the path.
6962
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006963 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6964 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6965 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6966 when improperly combined.
6967
6968 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6969 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6970 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6971 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6972 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6973
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006974 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006975
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006976 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6977
6978 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6979 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6980
6981 Example:
6982 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6983
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006984 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6985
6986 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6987 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6988
6989 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6990 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6991
6992 Example:
6993 - /#foo -> /
6994
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006995 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6996 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006997
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006998 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6999 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
7000
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02007001 Example:
7002 - /. -> /
7003 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
7004 - /a/./a -> /a/a
7005 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007006
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02007007 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
7008 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
7009
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007010 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007011 their preceding segment.
7012
7013 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
7014 normalizer first if this is undesired.
7015
7016 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
7017 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007018
7019 Example:
7020 - /foo/../ -> /
7021 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
7022 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
7023 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02007024 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007025 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007026 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007027
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02007028 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
7029 removed as well:
7030
7031 Example:
7032 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
7033 - /bar/../../ -> /
7034
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007035 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
7036 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007037
7038 Example:
7039 - // -> /
7040 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
7041
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007042 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
7043 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
7044
7045 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
7046 ".", "_", and "~".
7047
7048 Example:
7049 - /%61dmin -> /admin
7050 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
7051 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
7052 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
7053
7054 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7055 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7056
7057 Example:
7058 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
7059 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
7060
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007061 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02007062 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02007063
7064 Example:
7065 - /%6f -> /%6F
7066 - /%zz -> /%zz
7067
7068 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7069 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7070
7071 Example:
7072 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
7073
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007074 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02007075 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
7076 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
7077
7078 Example:
7079 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
7080 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
7081 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
7082
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007083http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007084
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007085 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
7086 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
7087 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
7088 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
7089 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007090
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007091http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007092
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007093 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
7094 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
7095 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
7096 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007097
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007098http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7099 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02007100
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007101 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007102 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
7103 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
7104 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
7105 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
7106 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02007107
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007108 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
7109 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
7110 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
7111 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
7112 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007113
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007114 Example:
7115 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
7116
7117 # applied to:
7118 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7119
7120 # outputs:
7121 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7122
7123 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007124
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007125 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
7126
7127 # applied to:
7128 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007129
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007130 # outputs:
7131 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007132
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007133http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7134 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7135
7136 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
7137 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02007138 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
7139 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
7140 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007141
7142 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7143 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7144 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
7145
7146 Example:
7147 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7148 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
7149
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007150 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
7151 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
7152 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
7153 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
7154
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007155http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7156 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7157
7158 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
7159 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
7160 query-string are replaced.
7161
7162 Example:
7163 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
7164 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
7165
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007166http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7167 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7168
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007169 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
7170 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
7171 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
7172 against.
7173
7174 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7175 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7176 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007177
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007178 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
7179 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
7180 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
7181 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
7182 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
7183 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
7184 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
7185 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
7186 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007187 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
7188 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007189
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007190 Example:
7191 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
7192 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007193
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007194 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7195 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007196
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007197http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7198 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007199
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007200 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
7201 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
7202 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
7203 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007204
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007205 Example:
7206 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007207
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007208 # applied to:
7209 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007210
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007211 # outputs:
7212 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007213
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007214http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7215 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7216 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01007217 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007218 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7219
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007220 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007221 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7222 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007223 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007224 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007225 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007226 are followed to create the response :
7227
7228 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7229 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7230 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7231 ignored.
7232
7233 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7234 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007235 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007236 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7237 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007238
7239 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7240 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7241 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007242 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007243 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007244
7245 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7246 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7247 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007248 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007249 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007250 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007251
7252 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7253 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7254 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7255 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7256 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7257 as a raw content.
7258
7259 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7260 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7261 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7262 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7263 considered as a raw string.
7264
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007265 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007266 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7267 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7268 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7269
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007270 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7271 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007272 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007273
7274 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7275
7276 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007277 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007278 if { path /ping }
7279
7280 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
7281 if { path /favicon.ico }
7282
7283 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
7284 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
7285 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
7286
Willy Tarreau5a72d032023-01-02 18:15:20 +01007287http-request sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7288 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7289
7290 This action increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
7291 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> by the value of
7292 either integer <int> or the integer evaluation of expression <expr>. Integers
7293 and expressions are limited to unsigned 32-bit values. If an error occurs,
7294 this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues. <idx> is an
7295 integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer between 0 and 2. It also
7296 silently fails if the there is no GPC stored at this index. The entry in the
7297 table is refreshed even if the value is zero. The 'gpc_rate' is automatically
7298 adjusted to reflect the average growth rate of the gpc value.
7299
7300 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7301 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7302 There is no equivalent function for legacy data types, but if the value is
7303 always 1, please see 'sc-inc-gpc()', 'sc-inc-gpc0()' and 'sc-inc-gpc1()'.
7304 There is no way to decrement the value either, but it is possible to store
7305 exact values in a General Purpose Tag using 'sc-set-gpt()' instead.
7306
7307 The main use of this action is to count scores or total volumes (e.g.
7308 estimated danger per source IP reported by the server or a WAF, total
7309 uploaded bytes, etc).
7310
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007311http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7312
7313 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7314 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7315 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7316 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7317 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7318 at this index.
7319 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7320 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7321
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007322http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7323http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007324
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007325 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7326 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7327 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007328
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007329http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7330 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7331 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7332 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7333 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7334 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7335 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7336 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7337 at this index.
7338 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7339 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7340
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007341http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7342 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007343
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007344 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7345 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7346 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7347 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007348
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007349http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7350 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7351
7352 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7353 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7354 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7355 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7356 agent name must be used.
7357
7358 Arguments:
7359 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
7360
7361 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7362 configuration.
7363
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007364http-request set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
7365 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007366
7367 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
7368 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Custom
7369 limit and period may be defined, if and only if <name> references a
7370 per-stream bandwidth limitation filter. When a set-bandwidth-limit rule is
7371 executed, it first resets all settings of the filter to their defaults prior
7372 to enabling it. As a consequence, if several "set-bandwidth-limit" actions
7373 are executed for the same filter, only the last one is considered. Several
7374 bandwidth limitation filters can be enabled on the same stream.
7375
7376 Note that this action cannot be used in a defaults section because bandwidth
7377 limitation filters cannot be defined in defaults sections. In addition, only
7378 the HTTP payload transfer is limited. The HTTP headers are not considered.
7379
7380 Arguments:
7381 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7382 by some converters. The result is converted to an integer. It is
7383 interpreted as a size in bytes for the "limit" parameter and as a
7384 duration in milliseconds for the "period" parameter.
7385
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007386 <size> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
7387 bytes.
7388
7389 <time> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in
7390 milliseconds.
7391
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007392 Example:
7393 http-request set-bandwidth-limit global-limit
7394 http-request set-bandwidth-limit my-limit limit 1m period 10s
7395
7396 See section 9.7 about bandwidth limitation filter setup.
7397
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007398http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007400 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
7401 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
7402 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
7403 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
7404 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007406 Arguments:
7407 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7408 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007409
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007410 Example:
7411 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
7412 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007413
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007414 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
7415 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007416
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007417http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007418
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007419 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
7420 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
7421 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007422
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007423 Arguments:
7424 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7425 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007426
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007427 Example:
7428 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
7429 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007430
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007431 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
7432 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
7433 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007434
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007435http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007436
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007437 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
7438 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7439 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7440 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
7441 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007442
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007443 Example:
7444 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
7445 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
7446 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
7447 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
7448 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
7449 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
7450 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
7451 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
7452 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007453
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007454http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007455
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007456 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7457 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7458 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7459 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
7460 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007461
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007462http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7463 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007464
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007465 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7466 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7467 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7468 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7469 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
7470 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
7471 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
7472 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
7473 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007474
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007475http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007476
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007477 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7478 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7479 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7480 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
7481 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7482 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7483 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007484 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7485 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007486
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007487http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007488
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007489 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
7490 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
7491 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007492
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007493http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007494
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007495 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
7496 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
7497 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
7498 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
7499 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
7500 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7501 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7502 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007503
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007504http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007505
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007506 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
7507 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
7508 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
7509 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
7510 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
7511 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007512
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007513 Example :
7514 # prepend the host name before the path
7515 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007516
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007517http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7518
7519 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
7520 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
7521 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
7522
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007523http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02007524
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007525 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
7526 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
7527 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7528 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
7529 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007530
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007531http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007532
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007533 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
7534 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
7535 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7536 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
7537 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
7538 values have higher priority.
7539 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
7540 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
7541 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
7542 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
7543 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007544
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007545http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007546
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007547 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7548 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7549 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7550 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7551 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7552 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7553 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007554
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007555 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007556
7557 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007558 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7559 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007560
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007561http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7562 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7563 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7564 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007565 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7566 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007567
7568 Arguments :
7569 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7570 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007571
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007572 See also "option forwardfor".
7573
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007574 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007575 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7576 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7577
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007578 # After the masking this will track connections
7579 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
7580 http-request track-sc0 src
7581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007582 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
7583 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
7584
7585http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7586
7587 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
7588 expression.
7589
7590 Arguments:
7591 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7592 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007593
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007594 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007595 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
7596 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
7597
7598 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
7599 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
7600 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
7601
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007602http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007603 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7604
7605 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
7606 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
7607 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
7608 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
7609 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
7610
7611 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
7612 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
7613 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
7614 results.
7615
7616 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007617 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
7618 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007620http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7621
7622 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7623 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
7624 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
7625 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
7626 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
7627 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
7628 information from the request.
7629
7630 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7631
7632http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7633
7634 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
7635 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulet84cdbe42022-11-22 15:41:48 +01007636 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
7637 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
7638 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
7639 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
7640 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007641 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
7642
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007643http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7644http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007645
7646 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7647 inline.
7648
7649 Arguments:
7650 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7651 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7652 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7653 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7654 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7655 (request and response)
7656 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7657 processing
7658 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7659 processing
7660 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7661 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
7662 and '_'.
7663
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007664 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
7665 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05007666 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007667 conditions.
7668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007669 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7670 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007671
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007672 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
7673 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
7674
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007675 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007676 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007677 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
7678
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007679http-request silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007680
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007681 This stops the evaluation of the rules and removes the client-facing
7682 connection in a configurable way: When called without the rst-ttl argument,
7683 we try to prevent sending any FIN or RST packet back to the client by
7684 using TCP_REPAIR. If this fails (mainly because of missing privileges),
7685 we fall back to sending a RST packet with a TTL of 1.
7686
7687 The effect is that the client still sees an established connection while
7688 there is none on HAProxy, saving resources. However, stateful equipment
7689 placed between the HAProxy and the client (firewalls, proxies,
7690 load balancers) will also keep the established connection in their
7691 session tables.
7692
7693 The optional rst-ttl changes this behaviour: TCP_REPAIR is not used,
7694 and a RST packet with a configurable TTL is sent. When set to a
7695 reasonable value, the RST packet travels through your own equipment,
7696 deleting the connection in your middle-boxes, but does not arrive at
7697 the client. Future packets from the client will then be dropped
7698 already by your middle-boxes. These "local RST"s protect your resources,
7699 but not the client's. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007700
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007701http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007702
7703 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7704 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7705 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7706 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7707 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007708 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007709 processing.
7710
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007711 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007712 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
7713 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
7714 rules evaluation.
7715
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007716http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7717http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7718 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7719 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7720 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7721 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007722
7723 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
7724 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
7725 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007726 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
7727 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
7728 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
7729 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
7730 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
7731 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007732 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007733 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
7734 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
7735 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007736 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007737 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7738 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7739 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
7740 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7741 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007742
7743http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7744http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7745http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7746
7747 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
7748 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01007749 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set by the
7750 global "tune.stick-counters" setting, which defaults to MAX_SESS_STKCTR if
7751 set at build time (it is reported in haproxy -vv) and which defaults to 3,
7752 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (tune.stick-counters-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007753 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7754 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
7755 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
7756 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7757 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
7758 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
7759 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
7760
7761 Arguments :
7762 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
7763 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
7764 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
7765 select which table entry to update the counters.
7766
7767 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
7768 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
7769 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
7770 that table until the session ends.
7771
7772 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
7773 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
7774 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
7775 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
7776 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
7777 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
7778 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
7779 useful information.
7780
7781 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
7782 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
7783 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
7784 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7785 checks that make use of it.
7786
7787http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7788
7789 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007790
7791 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007792 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007793
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007794http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7795
7796 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7797 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7798 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7799 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7800 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7801 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7802
7803 Arguments :
7804 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7805
7806 Example:
7807 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7808
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007809http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7810 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7811
7812 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7813 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7814 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7815 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7816 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7817 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7818 http-buffer-request".
7819
7820 Arguments :
7821
7822 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7823 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7824
7825 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007826 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007827 bytes.
7828
7829 Example:
7830 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7831
7832 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7833
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007834http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007835
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007836 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7837 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7838 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007839
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007840
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007841http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007842 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7843
7844 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007845 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007846
7847 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7848 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7849 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7850 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7851 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7852 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7853
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007854 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7855 supported:
7856 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7857 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7858 - allow
7859 - cache-store <name>
7860 - capture <sample> id <id>
7861 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7862 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7863 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7864 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7865 - redirect <rule>
7866 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7867 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7868 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01007869 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007870 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7871 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7872 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7873 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7874 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7875 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007876 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007877 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7878 - set-log-level <level>
7879 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7880 - set-mark <mark>
7881 - set-nice <nice>
7882 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7883 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007884 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
7885 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +01007886 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007887 - strict-mode { on | off }
7888 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7889 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7890 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7891 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7892 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7893
7894 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007895
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007896 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007897
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007898 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7899 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7900 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7901 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7902 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7903 a defaults section defining such rules.
7904
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007905 Example:
7906 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007907
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007908 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007909
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007910 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7911 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007912
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007913 Example:
7914 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007915
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007916 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007917
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007918 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7919 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007920
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007921 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7922 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007923
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007924http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007925
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007926 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7927 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007928
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007929http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007930
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007931 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007932 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
7933 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007934
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007935http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007936
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007937 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7938 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007939
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007940http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007941
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007942 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007944http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007945
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007946 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7947 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7948 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7949 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7950 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7951 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7952 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007953
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007954 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7955 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7956 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7957 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7958 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007959
7960 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7961 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7962 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7963 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007964
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007965http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007966
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007967 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7968 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007969
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007970http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007971
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007972 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
7973 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007974
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007975http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007976
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007977 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7978 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007979
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007980http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7981http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7982 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7983 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7984 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7985 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007986
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007987 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7988 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7989 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007990 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007991 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7992 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7993 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007994 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007995 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007996
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007997http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007998
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007999 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
8000 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
8001 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
8002 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
8003 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
8004 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02008005
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008006http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8007 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02008008
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01008009 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
8010 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01008011
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008012 Example:
8013 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02008014
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008015 # applied to:
8016 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008017
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008018 # outputs:
8019 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008020
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008021 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008022
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008023http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8024 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008025
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01008026 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01008027 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008029 Example:
8030 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008031
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008032 # applied to:
8033 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008034
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008035 # outputs:
8036 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008037
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008038http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
8039 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8040 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01008041 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008042 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8043
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008044 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
8045 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
8046 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008047
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01008048http-response sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8049 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8050
8051 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
8052 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
8053 a complete description.
8054
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02008055http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008056http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8057http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08008058
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008059 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
8060 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
8061 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
8062 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008063
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02008064http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008065 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01008066http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8067 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008068
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008069 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
8070 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
8071 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008072
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02008073http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
8074 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008075
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008076 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
8077 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02008078
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008079http-response set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
8080 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02008081
8082 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
8083 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
8084 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
8085
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008086http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008087
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008088 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
8089 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
8090 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
8091 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008092
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008093http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8094
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008095 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
8096 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008097
8098http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8099
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008100 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8101 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008102
8103http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8104
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008105 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
8106 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
8107 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008108
8109http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8110
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008111 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
8112 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008113
8114http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8115 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8116
8117 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
8118 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
8119 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
8120 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008121
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008122 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008123 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
8124 http-response set-status 431
8125 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
8126 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008127
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008128http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008129
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008130 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008131 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
8132 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008133
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01008134http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8135http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008136
8137 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008138 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
8139 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008140
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008141http-response silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008142
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008143 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
8144 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008145 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
8146 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008147
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008148http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008149
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008150 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
8151 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008152
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008153http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8154http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8155http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008156
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008157 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
8158 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
8159 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008160
8161http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8162
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008163 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008164 about <var-name>.
8165
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008166http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8167 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8168
8169 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008170 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
8171 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008172
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02008173
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008174http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
8175 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
8176
8177 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8178 yes | no | yes | yes
8179
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008180 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008181 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
8182 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
8183 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008184
8185 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
8186
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008187 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
8188 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
8189 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
8190 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
8191 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
8192 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
8193 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008194 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008195 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
8196 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008197
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008198 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
8199 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
8200 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
8201 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
8202 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
8203 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
8204 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02008205 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
8206 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
8207 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
8208 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
8209 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
8210 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008211
8212 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
8213 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
8214 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
8215 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
8216 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
8217 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
8218 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
8219 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02008220 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008221 downsides of rare connection failures.
8222
8223 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
8224 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
8225 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
8226 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
8227 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
8228 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008229 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008230 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
8231 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
8232 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
8233 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
8234 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
8235
8236 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008237 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
8238 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
8239 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
8240 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008241
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008242 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
8243 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008244
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01008245 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008246
8247 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
8248 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
8249 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
8250
Willy Tarreau44fce8b2022-11-25 09:17:18 +01008251 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
8252 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
8253 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
8254 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
8255 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
8256 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
8257 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
8258 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
8259 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
8260 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
8261 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
8262
8263 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
8264 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
8265 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
8266 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
8267 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
8268
8269 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
8270 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008271
8272
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008273http-send-name-header [<header>]
8274 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008275 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8276 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008277 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008278 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
8279
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02008280 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
8281 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
8282 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
8283 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
8284 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
8285 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
8286 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
8287 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
8288 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
8289 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
8290 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
8291 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
8292 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
8293 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
8294 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
8295 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008296
8297 See also : "server"
8298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008299id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008300 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
8301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8302 no | yes | yes | yes
8303 Arguments : none
8304
8305 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
8306 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
8307 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008308
8309
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008310ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
8311 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
8312 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01008313 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008314
8315 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
8316 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
8317 and running).
8318
8319 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
8320 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
8321 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008322 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008323 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
8324
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008325 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
8326 "unless" condition is met.
8327
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008328 Example:
8329 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8330 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8331 ignore-persist if url_static
8332
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008333 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
8334
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008335load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
8336 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
8337 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8338 yes | no | yes | yes
8339
8340 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
8341 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
8342 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008343 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008344 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008345 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
8346 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
8347 over the stats socket and redirect output.
8348
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008349 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008350 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02008351 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008352
8353 Arguments:
8354 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
8355 named "server-state-file".
8356
8357 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
8358 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
8359 name is used as a file name.
8360
8361 none don't load any stat for this backend
8362
8363 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008364 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
8365 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
8366 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008367 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008368 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008369
8370 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
8371 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
8372
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008373 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008374
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008375 global
8376 stats socket /tmp/socket
8377 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008378
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008379 defaults
8380 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008381
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008382 backend bk
8383 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8384 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008385
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008386
8387 Then one can run :
8388
8389 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
8390
8391 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
8392
8393 1
8394 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8395 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8396 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8397
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008398 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008399
8400 global
8401 stats socket /tmp/socket
8402 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
8403
8404 defaults
8405 load-server-state-from-file local
8406
8407 backend bk
8408 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8409 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
8410
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008411
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008412 Then one can run :
8413
8414 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
8415
8416 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
8417
8418 1
8419 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8420 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8421 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8422
8423 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
8424 "show servers state"
8425
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008426
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008427log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01008428log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008429 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008430no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008431 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
8432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8433 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008434
8435 Prefix :
8436 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
8437 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
8438 prefix does not allow arguments.
8439
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008440 Arguments :
8441 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
8442 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
8443 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
8444 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
8445 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
8446 parameter.
8447
8448 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
8449 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
8450
8451 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
8452 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8453 standard syslog port).
8454
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01008455 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
8456 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8457 standard syslog port).
8458
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008459 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
8460 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
8461 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008462 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008463
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008464 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
8465 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
8466 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
8467 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
8468 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
8469 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
8470 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
8471 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
8472 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
8473 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
8474 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
8475 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008476 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008477 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
8478 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
8479 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008480 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
8481 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008482
8483 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
8484 and "fd@2", see above.
8485
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02008486 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
8487 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
8488 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
8489 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
8490 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
8491 having the logs instantly available.
8492
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008493 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
8494 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
8495 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
8496
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008497 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8498 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008499
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008500 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
8501 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
8502 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
8503 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
8504 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
8505 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
8506 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
8507 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
8508 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
8509 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008510 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008511
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008512 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
8513 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
8514 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
8515 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
8516 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
8517
8518 <sample_size>
8519 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
8520 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
8521 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
8522 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
8523 (see also <ranges> parameter).
8524
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008525 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
8526 one of the following :
8527
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01008528 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
8529 field is stripped. This is the default.
8530 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
8531 rfc3164.
8532
8533 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008534 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
8535
8536 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
8537 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
8538
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008539 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
8540 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
8541 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8542 designed to be used with a local log server.
8543
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008544 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8545 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
8546 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
8547 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
8548 systemd logger consumes.
8549
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008550 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8551 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
8552 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
8553 used with a local log server.
8554
8555 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
8556 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8557 designed to be used with a local log server.
8558
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008559 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
8560 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
8561 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
8562 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
8563
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008564 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
8565
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008566 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
8567 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
8568 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
8569
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008570 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
8571 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
8572 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
8573 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008574
8575 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
8576 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
8577 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008578 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
8579 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
8580 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
8581 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
8582 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008583
8584 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
8585
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008586 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
8587 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
8588 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008589
8590 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
8591 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
8592 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
8593 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
8594
8595 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
8596 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008597
8598 Example :
8599 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008600 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
8601 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
8602 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008603 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008604 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
8605 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008606 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008607
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008608
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008609log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008610 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
8611 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8612 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008613
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008614 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
8615 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
8616 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
8617 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
8618 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02008619 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
8620 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008621
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008622 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
8623 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008624
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02008625log-format-sd <string>
8626 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
8627 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8628 yes | yes | yes | no
8629
8630 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
8631 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
8632 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
8633 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
8634 which covers the log format string in depth.
8635
8636 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
8637 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
8638
8639 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
8640 log format to "rfc5424".
8641
8642 Example :
8643 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
8644
8645
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008646log-tag <string>
8647 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
8648 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8649 yes | yes | yes | yes
8650
8651 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
8652 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008653 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008654 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
8655 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
8656 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
8657 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
8658 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
8659 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008660
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008661max-keep-alive-queue <value>
8662 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
8663 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8664 yes | no | yes | yes
8665
8666 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
8667 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
8668 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
8669 servers.
8670
8671 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008672 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008673 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
8674 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8675 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008676 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008677 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8678 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8679 picking a different server.
8680
8681 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8682 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8683 even if they have to be queued.
8684
8685 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8686 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8687
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008688max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8689 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8690 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8691 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008692
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008693maxconn <conns>
8694 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8696 yes | yes | yes | no
8697 Arguments :
8698 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8699 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8700 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8701 closes.
8702
8703 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008704 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008705 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8706 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008707 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8708 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8709 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8710 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008711
8712 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8713 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8714 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8715
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008716 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8717 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008718
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008719 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8720
8721
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008722mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008723 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8725 yes | yes | yes | yes
8726 Arguments :
8727 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8728 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8729 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8730 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8731
8732 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8733 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8734 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8735 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8736 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8737
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008738 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8739 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8740 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008741
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008742 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008743 defaults http_instances
8744 mode http
8745
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008746
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008747monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008748 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8750 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008751 Arguments :
8752 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8753 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008754 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008755 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8756 backend and its backup.
8757
8758 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8759 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8760 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8761 servers in a list of backends.
8762
8763 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8764 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8765 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008766 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008767 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8768 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008769 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008770 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8771 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008772
8773 Example:
8774 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008775 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008776 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8777 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8778 monitor-uri /site_alive
8779 monitor fail if site_dead
8780
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008781 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008782
8783
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008784monitor-uri <uri>
8785 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8787 yes | yes | yes | no
8788 Arguments :
8789 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8790 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8791
8792 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8793 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8794 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8795 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8796 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8797 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8798 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8799 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8800
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008801 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008802 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8803 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau7fe0c622022-11-25 10:24:44 +01008804 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
8805 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
8806 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008807 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8808 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8809 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008810
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008811 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8812 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8813 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8814 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8815
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008816 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008817 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008818 frontend www
8819 mode http
8820 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8821
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008822 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008823
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008824
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008825option abortonclose
8826no option abortonclose
8827 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8829 yes | no | yes | yes
8830 Arguments : none
8831
8832 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8833 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8834 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8835 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008836 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008837 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8838 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8839 encountered while delivering the response.
8840
8841 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8842 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8843 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8844 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8845 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8846 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008847 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008848 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008849 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008850 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8851 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8852 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8853
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008854 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8855 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008856 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8857 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8858 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8859 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8860 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8861 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008862 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008863
8864 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8865 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8866
8867 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8868
8869
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008870option accept-invalid-http-request
8871no option accept-invalid-http-request
8872 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8874 yes | yes | yes | no
8875 Arguments : none
8876
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008877 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008878 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008879 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008880 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8881 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8882 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8883 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8884 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008885 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8886 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8887 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8888 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008889 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008890 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008891 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
Willy Tarreau1ba30162022-05-24 15:34:26 +02008892 to pass through (no version specified), as well as different protocol names
8893 (e.g. RTSP), and multiple digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008894
8895 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8896 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8897 been confirmed.
8898
8899 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8900 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008901 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8902 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008903 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8904
8905 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8906 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8907
8908 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8909 stats socket.
8910
8911
8912option accept-invalid-http-response
8913no option accept-invalid-http-response
8914 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8916 yes | no | yes | yes
8917 Arguments : none
8918
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008919 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008920 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008921 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008922 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8923 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8924 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8925 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8926 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008927 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8928 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8929 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008930
8931 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8932 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8933 been confirmed.
8934
8935 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8936 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8937 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8938 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8939
8940 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8941 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8942
8943 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8944 stats socket.
8945
8946
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008947option allbackups
8948no option allbackups
8949 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8951 yes | no | yes | yes
8952 Arguments : none
8953
8954 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8955 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8956 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8957 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8958 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8959 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8960 order between the backup servers anymore.
8961
8962 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8963 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8964
8965 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8966 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8967
8968
8969option checkcache
8970no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008971 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8973 yes | no | yes | yes
8974 Arguments : none
8975
8976 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8977 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008978 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008979 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8980 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008981 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008982
8983 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008984 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008985 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008986 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8987 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008988 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008989 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008990 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8991 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008992 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008993 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8994 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008995 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008996 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8997 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8998 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8999 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
9000 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
9001 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
9002 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
9003 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
9004 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
9005
9006 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009007 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
9008 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
9009 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
9010 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009011
9012 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
9013 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009014 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009015 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009016
9017 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9018 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9019
9020
9021option clitcpka
9022no option clitcpka
9023 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
9024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9025 yes | yes | yes | no
9026 Arguments : none
9027
9028 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9029 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009030 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009031 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9032
9033 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9034 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9035 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9036 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9037
9038 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9039 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9040 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9041 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9042 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9043
9044 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9045
9046 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9047 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9048 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
9049
9050 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9051 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9052
9053 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
9054
9055
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009056option contstats
9057 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
9058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9059 yes | yes | yes | no
9060 Arguments : none
9061
9062 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
9063 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
9064 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009065 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01009066 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
9067 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
9068 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
9069 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
9070 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009071
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009072option disable-h2-upgrade
9073no option disable-h2-upgrade
9074 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
9075 connection.
9076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9077 yes | yes | yes | no
9078 Arguments : none
9079
9080 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
9081 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
9082 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
9083 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01009084 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
9085 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
9086 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
9087 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
9088 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
9089 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009090
9091 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9092 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009093
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009094option dontlog-normal
9095no option dontlog-normal
9096 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
9097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9098 yes | yes | yes | no
9099 Arguments : none
9100
9101 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
9102 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
9103 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
9104 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
9105 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
9106 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
9107 logged.
9108
9109 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
9110 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
9111 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
9112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009113 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009114 logging.
9115
9116
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009117option dontlognull
9118no option dontlognull
9119 Enable or disable logging of null connections
9120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9121 yes | yes | yes | no
9122 Arguments : none
9123
9124 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
9125 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
9126 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
9127 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
9128 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
9129 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009130 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
9131 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
9132 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009133
9134 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009135 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009136 would not be logged.
9137
9138 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9139 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9140
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009141 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009142 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009143
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009144option forwarded [ proto ]
9145 [ host | host-expr <host_expr> ]
9146 [ by | by-expr <by_expr> ] [ by_port | by_port-expr <by_port_expr>]
9147 [ for | for-expr <for_expr> ] [ for_port | for_port-expr <for_port_expr>]
9148no option forwarded
9149 Enable insertion of the rfc 7239 forwarded header in requests sent to servers
9150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9151 yes | no | yes | yes
9152 Arguments :
9153 <host_expr> optional argument to specify a custom sample expression
9154 those result will be used as 'host' parameter value
9155
9156 <by_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9157 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodename value
9158
9159 <for_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9160 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodename value
9161
9162 <by_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9163 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodeport value
9164
9165 <for_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9166 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodeport value
9167
9168
9169 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, servers are loosing some request
9170 context (request origin: client ip address, protocol used...)
9171
9172 A common way to address this limitation is to use the well known
9173 x-forward-for and x-forward-* friends to expose some of this context to the
9174 underlying servers/applications.
9175 While this use to work and is widely deployed, it is not officially supported
9176 by the IETF and can be the root of some interoperability as well as security
9177 issues.
9178
9179 To solve this, a new HTTP extension has been described by the IETF:
9180 forwarded header (RFC7239).
9181 More information here: https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html
9182
9183 The use of this single header allow to convey multiple informations
9184 within the same header, and most importantly, fixes the proxy chaining
9185 issue. (the rfc allows for multiple chained proxies to append their own
9186 values to an already existing header).
9187
9188 This option may be specified in defaults, listen or backend section, but it
9189 will be ignored for frontend sections.
9190
9191 Setting option forwarded without arguments results in using default implicit
9192 behavior.
9193 Default behavior enables proto parameter and injects original client ip.
9194
9195 The equivalent explicit/manual configuration would be:
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01009196 option forwarded proto for
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009197
9198 The keyword 'by' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9199 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9200 'by' value will be set to proxy ip (destination address)
9201 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'by' will be set to
9202 "unknown".
9203
9204 The keyword 'by-expr' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9205 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9206 'by' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9207 <by_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9208
9209 The keyword 'for' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9210 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9211 'for' value will be set to client ip (source address)
9212 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'for' will be set to
9213 "unknown".
9214
9215 The keyword 'for-expr' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9216 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9217 'for' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9218 <for_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9219
9220 The keyword 'by_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9221 'by' parameter. 'by_port' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9222 it will be ignored.
9223 "nodeport" will be set to proxy (destination) port if available,
9224 otherwise it will be ignored.
9225
9226 The keyword 'by_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9227 'by' parameter. 'by_port-expr' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9228 it will be ignored.
9229 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9230 <by_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9231
9232 The keyword 'for_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9233 'for' parameter. 'for_port' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9234 it will be ignored.
9235 "nodeport" will be set to client (source) port if available,
9236 otherwise it will be ignored.
9237
9238 The keyword 'for_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9239 'for' parameter. 'for_port-expr' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9240 it will be ignored.
9241 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9242 <for_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9243
9244 Examples :
9245 # Those servers want the ip address and protocol of the client request
9246 # Resulting header would look like this:
9247 # forwarded: proto=http;for=127.0.0.1
9248 backend www_default
9249 mode http
9250 option forwarded
9251 #equivalent to: option forwarded proto for
9252
9253 # Those servers want the requested host and hashed client ip address
9254 # as well as client source port (you should use seed for xxh32 if ensuring
9255 # ip privacy is a concern)
9256 # Resulting header would look like this:
9257 # forwarded: host="haproxy.org";for="_000000007F2F367E:60138"
9258 backend www_host
9259 mode http
9260 option forwarded host for-expr src,xxh32,hex for_port
9261
9262 # Those servers want custom data in host, for and by parameters
9263 # Resulting header would look like this:
9264 # forwarded: host="host.com";by=_haproxy;for="[::1]:10"
9265 backend www_custom
9266 mode http
9267 option forwarded host-expr str(host.com) by-expr str(_haproxy) for for_port-expr int(10)
9268
9269 # Those servers want random 'for' obfuscated identifiers for request
9270 # tracing purposes while protecting sensitive IP information
9271 # Resulting header would look like this:
9272 # forwarded: for=_000000002B1F4D63
9273 backend www_for_hide
9274 mode http
9275 option forwarded for-expr rand,hex
9276
9277 See also : "option forwardfor", "option originalto"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009278
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009279option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009280 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
9281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9282 yes | yes | yes | yes
9283 Arguments :
9284 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9285 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009286 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009287 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009288
9289 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
9290 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
9291 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
9292 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
9293 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
9294 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
9295 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009296 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
9297 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9298 possible that the client has already brought one.
9299
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009300 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009301 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009302 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009303 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009304 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009305 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009306
9307 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9308 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9309 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
9310 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
9311 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
9312 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01009313 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009314
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009315 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
9316 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009317 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009318 are under the control of the end-user.
9319
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009320 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009321 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9322 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009323 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
9324 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
9325 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009326
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02009327 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009328 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
9329 frontend www
9330 mode http
9331 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
9332
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009333 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
9334 backend www
9335 mode http
9336 option forwardfor header X-Client
9337
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009338 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009339 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009340
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009341
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02009342option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9343no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9344 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
9345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9346 yes | yes | yes | no
9347 Arguments : none
9348
9349 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9350 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9351 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9352 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9353 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9354 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9355 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9356
9357 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
9358 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
9359 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
9360 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9361 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
9362 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9363 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9364 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
9365 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9366 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9367
9368 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
9369
9370 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9371 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9372
9373 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
9374 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9375
9376
9377option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9378no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9379 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
9380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9381 yes | no | yes | yes
9382 Arguments : none
9383
9384 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9385 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9386 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9387 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9388 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9389 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9390 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9391
9392 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
9393 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
9394 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
9395 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9396 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
9397 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9398 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9399 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
9400 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9401 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9402
9403 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
9404
9405 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9406 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9407
9408 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
9409 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9410
9411
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009412option http-buffer-request
9413no option http-buffer-request
9414 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
9415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9416 yes | yes | yes | yes
9417 Arguments : none
9418
9419 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
9420 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
9421 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
9422 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
9423 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
9424 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01009425 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
9426 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
9427 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
9428 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009429
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02009430 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
9431 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009432
9433
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009434option http-ignore-probes
9435no option http-ignore-probes
9436 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
9437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9438 yes | yes | yes | no
9439 Arguments : none
9440
9441 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
9442 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
9443 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
9444 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
9445 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
9446 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
9447 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
9448 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
9449 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009450 was received over a connection before it was closed;
9451 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009452 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
9453
9454 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
9455 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
9456 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
9457 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
9458 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
9459 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
9460 are often the only way to detect them.
9461
9462 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9463 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9464
9465 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
9466
9467
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009468option http-keep-alive
9469no option http-keep-alive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009470 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server for HTTP/1.x
9471 connections
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9473 yes | yes | yes | yes
9474 Arguments : none
9475
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009476 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009477 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9478 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9479 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9480 httpclose". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be
9481 useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009482
9483 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
9484 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009485 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
9486 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
9487 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
9488 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
9489 situations where this option may be useful :
9490
9491 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009492 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009493
9494 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
9495 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
9496
9497 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009498
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009499 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9500 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9501 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9502 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
9503 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9504 not set.
9505
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009506 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009507 http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009508
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009509 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009510 "option prefer-last-server" and "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009511
9512
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009513option http-no-delay
9514no option http-no-delay
9515 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
9516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9517 yes | yes | yes | yes
9518 Arguments : none
9519
9520 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
9521 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
9522 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
9523 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
9524 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
9525 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
9526 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009527 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009528 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
9529 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
9530 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
9531 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
9532 affected.
9533
9534 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
9535 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
9536 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
9537 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
9538 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
9539 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
9540 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
9541 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
9542 latency environments.
9543
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009544 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
9545
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009546
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009547option http-pretend-keepalive
9548no option http-pretend-keepalive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009549 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive for HTTP/1.x connection to the
9550 server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009552 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009553 Arguments : none
9554
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009555 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009556 adds a "Connection: close" header to the HTTP/1.x request forwarded to the
9557 server. Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically
9558 refrain from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length,
9559 while this is totally unrelated. The effect is that a client or a cache could
9560 receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and consider the
9561 response complete.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009562
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009563 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009564 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009565 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009566 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009567 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009568 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
9569
9570 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
9571 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
9572 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
9573 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009574 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
9575 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009576 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
9577
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009578 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
9579 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
9580 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009581 frontend.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009582
9583 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9584 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9585
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009586 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009587 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009588
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02009589option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
9590 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
9591 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
9592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9593 yes | yes | yes | yes
9594 Arguments :
9595 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
9596 with no FastCGI application configured.
9597
9598 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
9599 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
9600 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
9601
9602 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
9603 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
9604
9605 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
9606 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
9607 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
9608 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
9609 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
9610 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
9611 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
9612 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
9613
9614 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
9615 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009616
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009617option http-server-close
9618no option http-server-close
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009619 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing on the server side
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9621 yes | yes | yes | yes
9622 Arguments : none
9623
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009624 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009625 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9626 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9627 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9628 httpclose". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close
9629 mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive
9630 and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the
9631 client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side
9632 to save server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
9633 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
9634 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
9635 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
9636 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
9637 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009638
9639 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9640 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9641 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9642 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009643 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9644 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009645
9646 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9647 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009648 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
9649 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9650 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009651
9652 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9653 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9654
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009655 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
9656 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009657
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009658option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009659no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009660 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
9661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9662 yes | yes | yes | no
9663 Arguments : none
9664
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00009665 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009666 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
9667 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
9668 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
9669 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
9670 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009671 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009672
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009673 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009674 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009675 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
9676 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
9677 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009678
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01009679 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
9680 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
9681 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
9682 front of an existing proxy.
9683
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009684 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
9685
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009686 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009687
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009688option httpchk
9689option httpchk <uri>
9690option httpchk <method> <uri>
9691option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009692 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9694 yes | no | yes | yes
9695 Arguments :
9696 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
9697 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
9698 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
9699 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
9700 ones.
9701
9702 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
9703 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
9704 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
9705
9706 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
9707 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
9708 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02009709 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009710
9711 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
9712 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
9713 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
9714 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
9715 the lack of any response.
9716
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009717 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
9718 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
9719 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
9720 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
9721
9722 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
9723 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
9724 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009725
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009726 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
9727 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009728 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04009729 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009730 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009731
9732 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009733 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
9734 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
9735 backend https_relay
9736 mode tcp
9737 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
9738 http-check send hdr Host www
9739 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009740
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009741 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
9742 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
9743 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009744
9745
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009746option httpclose
9747no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009748 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9750 yes | yes | yes | yes
9751 Arguments : none
9752
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009753 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009754 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9755 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9756 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9757 httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009758
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009759 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close the client or the server
Christopher Fauletd17dd842023-02-20 17:30:06 +01009760 connection, depending where the option is set. The frontend is considered for
9761 client connections while the backend is considered for server ones. If the
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009762 option is set on a listener, it is applied both on client and server
9763 connections. It will check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in
9764 each direction, and will add one if missing.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009765
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009766 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009767 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" request header, but will
9768 still cause the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009769
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009770 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009771 http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009772
9773 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9774 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9775
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009776 See also : "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009777
9778
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009779option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009780 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
9781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009782 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009783 Arguments :
9784 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
9785 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
9786 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009787 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009788 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009789
9790 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9791 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9792 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9793 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9794 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9795 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
9796 ports.
9797
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01009798 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
9799 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009800
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009801 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009803 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009804
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02009805option httpslog
9806 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
9807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9808 yes | yes | yes | no
9809
9810 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9811 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9812 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9813 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9814 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9815 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
9816 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
9817
9818 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9819
9820 See also : section 8 about logging.
9821
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009822
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009823option independent-streams
9824no option independent-streams
9825 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9827 yes | yes | yes | yes
9828 Arguments : none
9829
9830 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9831 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9832 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9833 receive data or not.
9834
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009835 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009836 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9837 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9838 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9839 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9840 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9841 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9842 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9843 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9844 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9845 socket buffers.
9846
9847 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9848 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9849 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9850 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9851 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9852
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009853 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009854
9855
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009856option ldap-check
9857 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9859 yes | no | yes | yes
9860 Arguments : none
9861
9862 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9863 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9864 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9865 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9866
9867 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9868 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9869
9870 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9871 configure it.
9872
9873 Example :
9874 option ldap-check
9875
9876 See also : "option httpchk"
9877
9878
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009879option external-check
9880 Use external processes for server health checks
9881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9882 yes | no | yes | yes
9883
9884 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9885 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9886 command".
9887
9888 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9889
9890 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9891
9892
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009893option idle-close-on-response
9894no option idle-close-on-response
9895 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9897 yes | yes | yes | no
9898 Arguments : none
9899
9900 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9901 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9902 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9903 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9904 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9905 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9906 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9907 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9908 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9909
9910 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9911 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9912
9913 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9914 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9915 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9916 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9917
9918 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9919 "hard-stop-after"
9920
9921
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009922option log-health-checks
9923no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009924 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9926 yes | no | yes | yes
9927 Arguments : none
9928
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009929 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9930 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9931 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009932
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009933 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9934 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9935 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9936 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9937 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9938
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009939 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009940 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009941
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009942 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9943 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9944 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009945
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009946
9947option log-separate-errors
9948no option log-separate-errors
9949 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9951 yes | yes | yes | no
9952 Arguments : none
9953
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009954 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009955 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9956 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9957 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9958 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9959 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9960 provides very important information.
9961
9962 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9963 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9964 error logs.
9965
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009966 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009967 logging.
9968
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009969
9970option logasap
9971no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009972 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9974 yes | yes | yes | no
9975 Arguments : none
9976
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009977 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9978 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9979 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9980 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9981
9982 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9983 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9984 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9985 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9986 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009987 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009988 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9989 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9990 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9991 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009992 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009993
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009994 Examples :
9995 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9996 mode http
9997 option httplog
9998 option logasap
9999 log 192.168.2.200 local3
10000
10001 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10002 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10003 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
10004 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010006 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010007 logging.
10008
10009
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +020010010option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010011 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10013 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010014 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010015 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
10016 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +020010017 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
10018 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010019
10020 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
10021 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010022 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010023 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +100010024 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
10025 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
10026 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010027
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +100010028 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
10029 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
10030 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010031
10032 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010033 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010034 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
10035 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
10036 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
10037 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
10038 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
10039 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
10040 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
10041
10042 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
10043 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010044
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +020010045 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010046
10047 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
10048 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
10049 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10050 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010051 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010052 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010053
10054 See also: "option httpchk"
10055
10056
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010057option nolinger
10058no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010059 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010060 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10061 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010062 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010063
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010064 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010065 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
10066 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
10067 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
10068 connections.
10069
10070 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
10071 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010072 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
10073 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
10074 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
10075 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
10076 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
10077 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
10078 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
10079 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
10080 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
10081 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
10082 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
10083 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
10084 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010085
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010086 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
10087 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
10088 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
10089 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
10090 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010091
10092 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
10093 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010094 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050010095 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010096 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010097
10098 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10099 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10100
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010101 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
10102 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010103
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010104option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
10105 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
10106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10107 yes | yes | yes | yes
10108 Arguments :
10109 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
10110 matching <network>
10111 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
10112 header name.
10113
10114 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
10115 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
10116 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
10117 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
10118 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
10119 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
10120 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
10121 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
10122 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
10123 possible that the client has already brought one.
10124
10125 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
10126 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
10127 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
10128 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
10129 header and requires different one.
10130
10131 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
10132 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
10133 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +010010134 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
10135 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
10136 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
10137 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
10138 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010139
10140 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
10141 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
10142 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
10143 both are defined.
10144
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010145 Examples :
10146 # Original Destination address
10147 frontend www
10148 mode http
10149 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
10150
10151 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
10152 backend www
10153 mode http
10154 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
10155
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010156 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010157
10158
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010159option persist
10160no option persist
10161 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
10162 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10163 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010164 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010165
10166 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
10167 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
10168 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
10169 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
10170 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
10171 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
10172 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
10173 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
10174 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
10175 redirected to another valid server.
10176
10177 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10178 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10179
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +010010180 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010181
10182
Christopher Faulet59307b32022-10-03 15:00:59 +020010183option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +010010184 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
10185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10186 yes | no | yes | yes
10187 Arguments :
10188 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
10189 PostgreSQL server.
10190
10191 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
10192 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
10193 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
10194 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
10195
10196 See also: "option httpchk"
10197
10198
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010199option prefer-last-server
10200no option prefer-last-server
10201 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
10202 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10203 yes | no | yes | yes
10204 Arguments : none
10205
10206 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010207 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010208 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
10209 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010210 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010211 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010212 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010213 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
10214 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010215 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010216 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +020010217 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
10218 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
10219 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010220 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
10221 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
10222 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010223
10224 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10225 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10226
10227 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
10228
10229
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010230option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010231option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010232no option redispatch
10233 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
10234 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10235 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010236 Arguments :
10237 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
10238 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
10239 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010240 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010241 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010242 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010243 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
10244 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
10245 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
10246
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010247
10248 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
10249 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
10250 be able to access the service anymore.
10251
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +010010252 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
10253 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010254
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +020010255 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
10256 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
10257 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
10258 following order:
10259
10260 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
10261
10262 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
10263 list, or
10264
10265 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
10266
10267 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
10268 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
10269
10270 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
10271 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
10272 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
10273 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
10274
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010275 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010276 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
10277 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010278
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010279 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10280 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10281
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010282 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010283
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010284
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010285option redis-check
10286 Use redis health checks for server testing
10287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10288 yes | no | yes | yes
10289 Arguments : none
10290
10291 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
10292 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10293 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
10294 find the "+PONG" response message.
10295
10296 Example :
10297 option redis-check
10298
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010299 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010300
10301
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010302option smtpchk
10303option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
10304 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
10305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10306 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010307 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010308 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +020010309 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010310 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
10311
10312 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
10313 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
10314 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
10315
10316 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
10317 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
10318 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
10319 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
10320 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
10321 dead server.
10322
10323 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
10324 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010325 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010326 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
10327
10328 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
10329 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
10330 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10331 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010332 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010333
10334 Example :
10335 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
10336
10337 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
10338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010339
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010340option socket-stats
10341no option socket-stats
10342
10343 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
10344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10345 yes | yes | yes | no
10346
10347 Arguments : none
10348
10349
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010350option splice-auto
10351no option splice-auto
10352 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
10353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10354 yes | yes | yes | yes
10355 Arguments : none
10356
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010357 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010358 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010359 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010360 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010361 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010362 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
10363 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
10364 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
10365 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10366
10367 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
10368 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
10369 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
10370 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
10371 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
10372 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
10373 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
10374 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
10375 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
10376 keyword.
10377
10378 Example :
10379 option splice-auto
10380
10381 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10382 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10383
10384 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
10385 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10386
10387
10388option splice-request
10389no option splice-request
10390 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
10391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10392 yes | yes | yes | yes
10393 Arguments : none
10394
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010395 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010396 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010397 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10398 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10399 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10400 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10401
10402 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10403
10404 Example :
10405 option splice-request
10406
10407 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10408 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10409
10410 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
10411 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10412
10413
10414option splice-response
10415no option splice-response
10416 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
10417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10418 yes | yes | yes | yes
10419 Arguments : none
10420
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010421 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010422 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010423 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10424 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10425 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10426 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10427
10428 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10429
10430 Example :
10431 option splice-response
10432
10433 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10434 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10435
10436 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
10437 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10438
10439
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010440option spop-check
10441 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
10442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +010010443 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010444 Arguments : none
10445
10446 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
10447 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10448 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
10449 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
10450
10451 Example :
10452 option spop-check
10453
10454 See also : "option httpchk"
10455
10456
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010457option srvtcpka
10458no option srvtcpka
10459 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
10460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10461 yes | no | yes | yes
10462 Arguments : none
10463
10464 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10465 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010466 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010467 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10468
10469 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10470 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10471 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10472 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10473
10474 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10475 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10476 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10477 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10478 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10479
10480 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10481
10482 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
10483 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
10484 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
10485
10486 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10487 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10488
10489 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
10490
10491
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010492option ssl-hello-chk
10493 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
10494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10495 yes | no | yes | yes
10496 Arguments : none
10497
10498 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
10499 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
10500 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
10501 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
10502 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
10503 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
10504 hello message.
10505
10506 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
10507 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
10508 messages, which is appreciable.
10509
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010510 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010511 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
10512 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010513
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010514 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
10515
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010516
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010517option tcp-check
10518 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
10519 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10520 yes | no | yes | yes
10521
10522 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
10523 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
10524
10525 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
10526 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
10527 attempt, which remains the default mode.
10528
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010529 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010530 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
10531 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
10532 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
10533 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
10534 only.
10535
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010536 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010537 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010538 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
10539 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
10540 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
10541
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010542 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010543 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
10544 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010545 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010546 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
10547 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
10548 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
10549 the respective protocols.
10550 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010551 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010552
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010553 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010554
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010555 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
10556 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
10557 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
10558 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010559
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010560 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
10561 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
10562 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010563
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010564
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010565 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010566 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010567 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010568 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010569
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010570 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010571 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010572 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010573
10574 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
10575 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010576 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010577 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010578 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010579 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010580 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010581 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010582 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10583 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010584 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010585 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10586 tcp-check expect string +OK
10587
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010588 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010589 (send many headers before analyzing)
10590 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010591 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010592 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
10593 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
10594 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
10595 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010596 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010597
10598
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010599 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010600
10601
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010602option tcp-smart-accept
10603no option tcp-smart-accept
10604 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
10605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10606 yes | yes | yes | no
10607 Arguments : none
10608
10609 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
10610 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
10611 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
10612 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
10613 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
10614 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
10615
10616 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
10617 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
10618 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
10619 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
10620
10621 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
10622 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
10623 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010624 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010625
10626 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
10627 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
10628 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
10629
10630 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
10631 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
10632 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
10633
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +020010634 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
10635
10636
10637option tcp-smart-connect
10638no option tcp-smart-connect
10639 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
10640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10641 yes | no | yes | yes
10642 Arguments : none
10643
10644 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
10645 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
10646 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
10647 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
10648 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
10649
10650 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
10651 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
10652 complex.
10653
10654 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
10655 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
10656 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
10657
10658 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10659 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10660
10661 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
10662
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010663
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010664option tcpka
10665 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
10666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10667 yes | yes | yes | yes
10668 Arguments : none
10669
10670 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10671 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010672 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010673 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10674
10675 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10676 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10677 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10678 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10679
10680 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10681 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10682 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10683 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10684 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10685
10686 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10687
10688 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
10689 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
10690 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
10691 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
10692 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
10693 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
10694 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
10695 backends.
10696
10697 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
10698
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010699
10700option tcplog
10701 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
10702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010703 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010704 Arguments : none
10705
10706 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10707 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10708 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
10709 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
10710 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
10711 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
10712 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
10713 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
10714
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020010715 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010717 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010718
10719
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010720option transparent
10721no option transparent
10722 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010724 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010725 Arguments : none
10726
10727 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
10728 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10729 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10730 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10731 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10732 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10733 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10734 appropriate server.
10735
10736 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10737 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10738
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010010739 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010740 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010741
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010742
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010743external-check command <command>
10744 Executable to run when performing an external-check
10745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10746 yes | no | yes | yes
10747
10748 Arguments :
10749 <command> is the external command to run
10750
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010751 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
10752
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010753 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010754
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010755 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
10756 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
10757 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
10758 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
10759 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
10760 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010761
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010762 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
10763
10764 Environment variables :
10765 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
10766 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
10767
10768 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
10769
10770 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
10771
10772 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
10773 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
10774 for a UNIX socket).
10775
10776 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
10777
10778 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
10779
10780 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
10781
10782 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
10783
10784 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
10785
10786 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
10787 socket).
10788
Willy Tarreau973cf902022-05-13 15:58:35 +020010789 HAPROXY_SERVER_SSL "0" when SSL is not used, "1" when it is used
10790
10791 HAPROXY_SERVER_PROTO The protocol used by this server, which can be one
10792 of "cli" (the haproxy CLI), "syslog" (syslog TCP
10793 server), "peers" (peers TCP server), "h1" (HTTP/1.x
10794 server), "h2" (HTTP/2 server), or "tcp" (any other
10795 TCP server).
10796
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010797 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
10798 the command may be set using "external-check path".
10799
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020010800 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
10801
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010802 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
10803 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
10804 failed.
10805
10806 Example :
10807 external-check command /bin/true
10808
10809 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10810
10811
10812external-check path <path>
10813 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10815 yes | no | yes | yes
10816
10817 Arguments :
10818 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10819
10820 The default path is "".
10821
10822 Example :
10823 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10824
10825 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10826 "external-check command"
10827
10828
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010829persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010830persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010831 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10833 yes | no | yes | yes
10834 Arguments :
10835 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010836 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10837 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010838
10839 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10840 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010841 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010842 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10843 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10844 forwarded to this server.
10845
10846 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10847 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10848 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010849 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010850 a single "listen" section.
10851
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010852 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10853 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10854 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10855
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010856 Example :
10857 listen tse-farm
10858 bind :3389
10859 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10860 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10861 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10862 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10863 persist rdp-cookie
10864 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010865 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010866 balance rdp-cookie
10867 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10868 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10869
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010870 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010871
10872
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010873rate-limit sessions <rate>
10874 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10876 yes | yes | yes | no
10877 Arguments :
10878 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10879 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10880
10881 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10882 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10883 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010884 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010885 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10886 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10887
10888 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10889 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10890 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10891 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10892
10893 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10894 listen smtp
10895 mode tcp
10896 bind :25
10897 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010898 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010899
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010900 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10901 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10902 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010903
10904 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10905
10906
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010907redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10908redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10909redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010910 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10912 no | yes | yes | yes
10913
10914 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010915 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010916
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010917 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010918 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010919 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10920 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10921 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010922
10923 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10924 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10925 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10926 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10927 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010928 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10929 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10930 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10931 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010932
10933 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10934 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10935 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10936 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10937 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10938 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010939 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010940 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010941 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10942 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10943 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010944
10945 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010946 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10947 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10948 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010949 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010950 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10951 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10952 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10953 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010954
10955 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010956 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010957
10958 - "drop-query"
10959 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10960 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10961 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10962 with a location-type redirect.
10963
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010964 - "append-slash"
10965 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10966 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10967 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10968 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10969
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010970 - "ignore-empty"
10971 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10972 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10973 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10974 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10975 of known paths using a simple map.
10976
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010977 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10978 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10979 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10980 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10981 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10982 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10983 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10984
10985 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10986 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10987 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10988 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10989 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10990 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10991 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010992
10993 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10994 acl clear dst_port 80
10995 acl secure dst_port 8080
10996 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010997 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010998 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010999 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
11000
11001 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010011002 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
11003 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
11004 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011005 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011006
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010011007 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
11008 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
11009 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
11010
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011011 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010011012 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011013
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011014 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020011015 http-request redirect code 301 location \
11016 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
11017 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011018
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020011019 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
11020 http-request redirect code 301 location \
11021 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
11022
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011023 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011024
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010011025
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011026retries <value>
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011027 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011028 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11029 yes | no | yes | yes
11030 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011031 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
11032 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011033
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011034 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
11035 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
11036 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
11037 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
11038 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011039
11040 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070011041 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011042 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011043
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011044 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
11045 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
11046 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011047
11048 See also : "option redispatch"
11049
11050
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011051retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020011052 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
11053 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
11054 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011055 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11056 yes | no | yes | yes
11057 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011058 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
11059 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
11060 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
11061 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
11062 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011063
11064 none never retry
11065
11066 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
11067 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
11068
11069 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
11070 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
11071 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
11072 request timeout on the server side, poor network
11073 condition, or a server crash or restart while
11074 processing the request.
11075
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020011076 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
11077 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
11078 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
11079 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
11080 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
11081 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
11082 overflow attack for example).
11083
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011084 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
11085 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
11086 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
11087 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
11088 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
11089 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
11090 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
11091 amplify denial of service attacks.
11092
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020011093 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
11094 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
11095 considered to be safe to retry.
11096
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010011097 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
11098 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
11099 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
11100 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
11101 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011102
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011103 all-retryable-errors
11104 retry request for any error that are considered
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +010011105 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
11106 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
11107 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011108
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011109 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
11110 not cumulative.
11111
11112 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
11113 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
11114 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
11115 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
11116
11117 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
11118 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
11119 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
11120 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
11121 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
11122 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
11123 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
11124 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
11125 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
11126 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
11127 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
11128 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
11129
11130 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
11131 should not use this directive.
11132
11133 The default is "conn-failure".
11134
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011135 Example:
11136 retry-on 503 504
11137
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011138 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
11139
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011140server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011141 Declare a server in a backend
11142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11143 no | no | yes | yes
11144 Arguments :
11145 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011146 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011147 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011148
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011149 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
11150 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
11151 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
11152 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011153 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
11154 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011155 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011156 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
11157 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011158 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
11159 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
11160 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
11161 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
11162 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11163 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11164 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011165 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020011166 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
11167 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
11168 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
11169 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
11170 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
11171 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011172 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11173 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011174 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
11175 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011176
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011177 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011178 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
11179 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
11180 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
11181 adding this value to the client's port.
11182
11183 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
11184 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011185 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011186
11187 Examples :
11188 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
11189 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011190 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011191 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
11192 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
11193 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011194
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020011195 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
11196 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
11197 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
11198 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
11199 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
11200
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011201 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
11202 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011203
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011204server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011205 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011206 this backend.
11207 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11208 no | no | yes | yes
11209
11210 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
11211 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
11212 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
11213 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
11214 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011215
11216 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
11217 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
11218
11219 global
11220 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
11221
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010011222 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011223 load-server-state-from-file
11224
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011225 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011226 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011227
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020011228server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
11229 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
11230 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
11231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11232 no | no | yes | yes
11233
11234 Arguments:
11235 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
11236
11237 <num | range>
11238 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
11239 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
11240 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
11241 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
11242
11243 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
11244
11245 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
11246
11247 <params*>
11248 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
11249 keyword.
11250
11251 Examples:
11252 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
11253 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
11254 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
11255
11256 # or
11257 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
11258
11259 # would be equivalent to:
11260 server srv1 google.com:80 check
11261 server srv2 google.com:80 check
11262 server srv3 google.com:80 check
11263
11264
11265
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011266source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011267source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011268source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011269 Set the source address for outgoing connections
11270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11271 yes | no | yes | yes
11272 Arguments :
11273 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
11274 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011275
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011276 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011277 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
11278 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
11279 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
11280 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
11281 supported prefixes are :
11282 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11283 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11284 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011285 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011286 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11287 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011288
11289 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
11290 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011291 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
11292 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
11293 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011294
11295 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
11296 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
11297 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
11298 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
11299 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
11300 <addr>.
11301
11302 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
11303 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
11304 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
11305 port.
11306
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011307 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
11308 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
11309 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
11310 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010011311 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011312 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
11313 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
11314 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
11315 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
11316 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
11317 HTTP header.
11318
11319 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
11320 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011321 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011322 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
11323 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11324 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
11325 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
11326 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
11327 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
11328 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
11329
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011330 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
11331 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
11332 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
11333 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
11334 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
11335 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
11336
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011337 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
11338 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
11339 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
11340 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
11341
11342 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
11343 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
11344 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
11345 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
11346 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
11347 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
11348
11349 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
11350 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
11351 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
11352 there are two methods :
11353
11354 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
11355 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
11356 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
11357 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
11358 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
11359 of the client ranges may be used.
11360
11361 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
11362 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
11363 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
11364 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
11365 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
11366 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
11367 same session.
11368
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011369 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
11370 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
11371 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011372 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011373
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020011374 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
11375
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011376 Examples :
11377 backend private
11378 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
11379 source 192.168.1.200
11380
11381 backend transparent_ssl1
11382 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
11383 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11384
11385 backend transparent_ssl2
11386 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
11387 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
11388 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
11389
11390 backend transparent_ssl3
11391 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
11392 # is more conntrack-friendly.
11393 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11394
11395 backend transparent_smtp
11396 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
11397 # with Tproxy version 4.
11398 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
11399
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011400 backend transparent_http
11401 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
11402 # proxy.
11403 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
11404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011405 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011406 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
11407
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011408
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011409srvtcpka-cnt <count>
11410 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
11411 the connection on the server side.
11412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11413 yes | no | yes | yes
11414 Arguments :
11415 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
11416
11417 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
11418 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011419 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11420 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011421
11422 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11423
11424
11425srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
11426 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
11427 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
11428 server side.
11429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11430 yes | no | yes | yes
11431 Arguments :
11432 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
11433 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
11434 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
11435 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
11436
11437 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
11438 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011439 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11440 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011441
11442 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11443
11444
11445srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
11446 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
11447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11448 yes | no | yes | yes
11449 Arguments :
11450 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
11451 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
11452 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
11453 document.
11454
11455 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
11456 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011457 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11458 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011459
11460 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
11461
11462
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011463stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
11464 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
11465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011466 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011467
11468 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
11469 matched.
11470
11471 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
11472 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
11473
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010011474 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
11475 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
11476 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
11477 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011478
11479 Example :
11480 # statistics admin level only for localhost
11481 backend stats_localhost
11482 stats enable
11483 stats admin if LOCALHOST
11484
11485 Example :
11486 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
11487 backend stats_auth
11488 stats enable
11489 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
11490 stats admin if TRUE
11491
11492 Example :
11493 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
11494 userlist stats-auth
11495 group admin users admin
11496 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
11497 group readonly users haproxy
11498 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
11499
11500 backend stats_auth
11501 stats enable
11502 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
11503 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
11504 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
11505 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
11506
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011507 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
11508 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011509
11510
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011511stats auth <user>:<passwd>
11512 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
11513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011514 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011515 Arguments :
11516 <user> is a user name to grant access to
11517
11518 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
11519
11520 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
11521 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
11522 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
11523 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
11524 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
11525 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
11526
11527 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
11528 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
11529 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011530 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011531
11532 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
11533 report using "stats scope".
11534
11535 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11536 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11537 unobvious parameters.
11538
11539 Example :
11540 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11541 backend public_www
11542 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11543 stats enable
11544 stats hide-version
11545 stats scope .
11546 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011547 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011548 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11549 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11550
11551 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11552 backend private_monitoring
11553 stats enable
11554 stats uri /admin?stats
11555 stats refresh 5s
11556
11557 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
11558
11559
11560stats enable
11561 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
11562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011563 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011564 Arguments : none
11565
11566 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
11567 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
11568 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
11569 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
11570 - stats auth : no authentication
11571 - stats scope : no restriction
11572
11573 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11574 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11575 unobvious parameters.
11576
11577 Example :
11578 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11579 backend public_www
11580 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11581 stats enable
11582 stats hide-version
11583 stats scope .
11584 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011585 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011586 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11587 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11588
11589 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11590 backend private_monitoring
11591 stats enable
11592 stats uri /admin?stats
11593 stats refresh 5s
11594
11595 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11596
11597
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011598stats hide-version
11599 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011601 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011602 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011603
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011604 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
11605 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
11606 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
11607 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
11608 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
11609 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011611 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11612 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11613 unobvious parameters.
11614
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011615 Example :
11616 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11617 backend public_www
11618 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011619 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011620 stats hide-version
11621 stats scope .
11622 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011623 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011624 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11625 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011626
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011627 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11628 backend private_monitoring
11629 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011630 stats uri /admin?stats
11631 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010011632
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011633 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011634
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011635
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020011636stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
11637 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
11638 Access control for statistics
11639
11640 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11641 no | no | yes | yes
11642
11643 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
11644 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
11645 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
11646 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
11647 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
11648 should be asked to enter a username and password.
11649
11650 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
11651 instance.
11652
11653 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
11654 about ACL usage.
11655
11656
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011657stats realm <realm>
11658 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
11659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011660 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011661 Arguments :
11662 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
11663 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
11664 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
11665
11666 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
11667 using a backslash ('\').
11668
11669 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
11670 only related to authentication.
11671
11672 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11673 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11674 unobvious parameters.
11675
11676 Example :
11677 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11678 backend public_www
11679 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11680 stats enable
11681 stats hide-version
11682 stats scope .
11683 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011684 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011685 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11686 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11687
11688 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11689 backend private_monitoring
11690 stats enable
11691 stats uri /admin?stats
11692 stats refresh 5s
11693
11694 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
11695
11696
11697stats refresh <delay>
11698 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
11699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011700 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011701 Arguments :
11702 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
11703 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
11704 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
11705 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
11706 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
11707 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
11708
11709 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
11710 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
11711 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050011712 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011713
11714 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11715 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11716 unobvious parameters.
11717
11718 Example :
11719 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11720 backend public_www
11721 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11722 stats enable
11723 stats hide-version
11724 stats scope .
11725 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011726 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011727 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11728 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11729
11730 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11731 backend private_monitoring
11732 stats enable
11733 stats uri /admin?stats
11734 stats refresh 5s
11735
11736 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11737
11738
11739stats scope { <name> | "." }
11740 Enable statistics and limit access scope
11741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011742 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011743 Arguments :
11744 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
11745 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
11746 section in which the statement appears.
11747
11748 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
11749 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
11750 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
11751 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
11752 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
11753 exists.
11754
11755 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11756 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11757 unobvious parameters.
11758
11759 Example :
11760 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11761 backend public_www
11762 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11763 stats enable
11764 stats hide-version
11765 stats scope .
11766 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011767 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011768 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11769 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11770
11771 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11772 backend private_monitoring
11773 stats enable
11774 stats uri /admin?stats
11775 stats refresh 5s
11776
11777 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11778
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011779
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011780stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011781 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
11782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011783 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011784
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011785 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011786 description from global section is automatically used instead.
11787
11788 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11789 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
11790
11791 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11792 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011793 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011794
11795 Example :
11796 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11797 backend private_monitoring
11798 stats enable
11799 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
11800 stats uri /admin?stats
11801 stats refresh 5s
11802
11803 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
11804 global section.
11805
11806
11807stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011808 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
11809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11810 yes | yes | yes | yes
11811 Arguments : none
11812
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011813 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011814 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11815 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11816 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11817 - IP (socket, server)
11818 - cookie (backend, server)
11819
11820 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11821 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011822 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011823
11824 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11825
11826
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011827stats show-modules
11828 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11830 yes | yes | yes | yes
11831 Arguments : none
11832
11833 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11834 values as a tooltip.
11835
11836 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11837 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11838 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11839
11840 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11841
11842
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011843stats show-node [ <name> ]
11844 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011846 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011847 Arguments:
11848 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11849 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11850
11851 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11852 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011853 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011854
11855 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11856 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11857 unobvious parameters.
11858
11859 Example:
11860 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11861 backend private_monitoring
11862 stats enable
11863 stats show-node Europe-1
11864 stats uri /admin?stats
11865 stats refresh 5s
11866
11867 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11868 section.
11869
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011870
11871stats uri <prefix>
11872 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011874 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011875 Arguments :
11876 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11877 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11878 query string.
11879
11880 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11881 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11882 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11883 possible to reach it in the application.
11884
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011885 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011886 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011887 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11888 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11889 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11890 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11891
11892 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11893 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11894 an address or a port to statistics only.
11895
11896 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11897 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11898 unobvious parameters.
11899
11900 Example :
11901 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11902 backend public_www
11903 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11904 stats enable
11905 stats hide-version
11906 stats scope .
11907 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011908 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011909 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11910 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11911
11912 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11913 backend private_monitoring
11914 stats enable
11915 stats uri /admin?stats
11916 stats refresh 5s
11917
11918 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11919
11920
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011921stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11922 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011924 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011925
11926 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011927 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011928 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011929 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011930 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11931
11932 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11933 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11934 the "stick-table" statement.
11935
11936 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11937 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11938 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11939 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11940 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11941
11942 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11943 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11944 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11945 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11946 transformation rules.
11947
11948 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11949 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11950 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11951 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11952 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11953 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11954 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11955
11956 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11957 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11958 ACL based conditions.
11959
11960 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11961 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11962 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11963 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11964
11965 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11966 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11967 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11968 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11969
11970 Example :
11971 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11972 # last 30 minutes
11973 backend pop
11974 mode tcp
11975 balance roundrobin
11976 stick store-request src
11977 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11978 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11979 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11980
11981 backend smtp
11982 mode tcp
11983 balance roundrobin
11984 stick match src table pop
11985 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11986 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11987
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011988 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11989 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011990
11991
11992stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11993 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11995 no | no | yes | yes
11996
11997 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11998 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11999 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
12000 for writing more maintainable configurations.
12001
12002 Examples :
12003 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010012004 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012005
12006 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
12007 stick match src table pop if !localhost
12008 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
12009
12010
12011 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
12012 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
12013 backend http
12014 mode http
12015 balance roundrobin
12016 stick on src table https
12017 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
12018 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
12019 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
12020
12021 backend https
12022 mode tcp
12023 balance roundrobin
12024 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12025 stick on src
12026 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12027 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12028
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012029 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012030
12031
12032stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
12033 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
12034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12035 no | no | yes | yes
12036
12037 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012038 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012039 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012040 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012041 server is selected.
12042
12043 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12044 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12045 the "stick-table" statement.
12046
12047 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12048 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12049 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
12050 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
12051 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
12052 address.
12053
12054 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12055 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
12056 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
12057 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
12058 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
12059 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
12060 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
12061 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
12062 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
12063 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
12064
12065 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12066 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12067 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12068 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12069 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12070 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12071 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12072
12073 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
12074 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12075 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
12076 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12077
12078 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
12079 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12080 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12081 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12082 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12083 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012084 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
12085 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12086 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12087 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12088 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12089 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012090
12091 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
12092 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
12093 the request.
12094
12095 Example :
12096 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12097 # last 30 minutes
12098 backend pop
12099 mode tcp
12100 balance roundrobin
12101 stick store-request src
12102 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12103 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12104 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12105
12106 backend smtp
12107 mode tcp
12108 balance roundrobin
12109 stick match src table pop
12110 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12111 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12112
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012113 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012114
12115
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012116stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012117 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012118 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080012119 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012121 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012122
12123 Arguments :
12124 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
12125 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
12126 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12127 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12128
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010012129 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
12130 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
12131 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12132 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12133
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012134 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
12135 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
12136 instance.
12137
12138 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
12139 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
12140 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
12141 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
12142 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
12143 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012144 to 32 characters.
12145
12146 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
12147 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
12148 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012149 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012150 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
12151 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012152
12153 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012154 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
12155 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012156 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
12157 increase.
12158
12159 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012160 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
12161 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
12162 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012163
12164 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012165 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012166 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
12167 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012168 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012169 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
12170 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
12171 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
12172 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
12173 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
12174 parameter (see below).
12175
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012176 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
12177 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
12178 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
12179 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
12180 soft restart.
12181
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012182 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012183 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
12184 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012185 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
12186 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012187 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012188 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012189 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
12190 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012191 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
12192 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012193
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012194 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
12195 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
12196 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
12197 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
12198 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
12199 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
12200 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
12201 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
12202 token.
12203
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012204 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
12205 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
12206 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
12207 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012208 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
12209 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
12210 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
12211 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
12212 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
12213 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
12214 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
12215 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
12216 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
12217 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
12218 types and their arguments.
12219
12220 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
12221 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
12222 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
12223 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
12224
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012225 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
12226 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
12227 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
12228 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
12229 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
12230 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
12231 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
12232 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
12233 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
12234 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012235 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
12236 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
12237 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
12238 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012239
12240 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
12241 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
12242 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
12243 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
12244 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
12245 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012246 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpt(100)
12247 allowing the storage of gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer
12248 update message can fit into the buffer.
12249 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpc(1) if you want to
12250 store only the counter gpc0.
12251 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012252 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
12253 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
12254 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012255 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
12256 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
12257 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
12258 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012259
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012260 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12261 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12262 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012263 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012264
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012265 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12266 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12267 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012268 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012269 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012270 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012271
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012272 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12273 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12274 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12275 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
12276
12277 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
12278 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12279 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
12280 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
12281 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
12282 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
12283
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012284 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
12285 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
12286 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
12287 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
12288 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012289 elements: gpt(100) allowing the storage of gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that
12290 the build of a peer update message can fit into the buffer.
12291 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpt(1) if you want to
12292 to store only the tag gpt0.
12293 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of counters will
12294 increase the data size and the traffic load using peers protocol since
12295 all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020012296 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
12297 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
12298 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012299
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020012300 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12301 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12302 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12303 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
12304
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012305 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12306 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
12307 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
12308 they were received.
12309
12310 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12311 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
12312 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
12313 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
12314 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
12315
12316 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12317 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12318 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12319 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
12320 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12321
12322 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12323 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
12324 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
12325
12326 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12327 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12328 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12329 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
12330 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12331
12332 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12333 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
12334 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
12335 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
12336 the client side.
12337
12338 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12339 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12340 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12341 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
12342 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
12343 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
12344 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
12345
12346 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12347 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
12348 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12349 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
12350 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
12351 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012352 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012353
12354 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12355 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12356 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12357 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12358 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
12359 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12360
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010012361 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12362 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
12363 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12364 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
12365 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
12366
12367 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12368 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12369 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12370 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12371 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
12372 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12373
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012374 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012375 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012376 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
12377 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
12378
12379 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12380 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12381 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12382 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12383 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12384 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
12385 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
12386 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
12387 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
12388 recommended for better fairness.
12389
12390 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012391 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012392 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
12393 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
12394
12395 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12396 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12397 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12398 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12399 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12400 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
12401 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
12402 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
12403 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
12404 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012405
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012406 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
12407 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012408 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
12409 reference it.
12410
12411 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
12412 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010012413 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
12414 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
12415 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012416
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012417 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
12418 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
12419 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
12420 something that can be ignored.
12421
12422 Example:
12423 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
12424 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
12425 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
12426 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
12427
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012428 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010012429 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012430
12431
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012432stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010012433 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12435 no | no | yes | yes
12436
12437 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012438 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012439 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012440 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012441 server is selected.
12442
12443 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12444 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12445 the "stick-table" statement.
12446
12447 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12448 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12449 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
12450 when the response is a SSL server hello.
12451
12452 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12453 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
12454 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
12455 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
12456 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
12457 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012458 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012459 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
12460 rules.
12461
12462 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12463 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12464 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12465 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12466 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12467 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12468 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12469
12470 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
12471 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12472 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
12473 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12474
12475 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
12476 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12477 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12478 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12479 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12480 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012481 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
12482 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12483 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12484 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12485 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12486 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
12487 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
12488 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
12489 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012490
12491 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
12492
12493 Example :
12494 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
12495 backend https
12496 mode tcp
12497 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012498 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012499 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012500
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012501 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
12502 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012503
12504 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
12505 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12506 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
12507
12508 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
12509 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012510
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012511 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
12512 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
12513 # at offset 44.
12514
12515 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012516 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012517
12518 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012519 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012520
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012521 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12522 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12523
12524 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
12525 extraction.
12526
12527
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012528tcp-check comment <string>
12529 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
12530 it fails.
12531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12532 yes | no | yes | yes
12533
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012534 Arguments :
12535 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
12536 rule fails.
12537
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012538 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
12539 user-friendly error reporting.
12540
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012541 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
12542 "tcp-check expect".
12543
12544
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012545tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
12546 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012547 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012548 Opens a new connection
12549 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012550 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012551
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012552 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012553 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12554
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012555 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012556 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012557
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012558 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012559 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
12560 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012561 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012562
12563 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012564
12565 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
12566
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020012567 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
12568
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012569 ssl opens a ciphered connection
12570
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020012571 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
12572
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020012573 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
12574 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
12575 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12576 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12577
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012578 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
12579 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
12580 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
12581 haproxy -vv.
12582
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012583 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012584
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012585 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
12586 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
12587 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
12588
12589 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
12590 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
12591 of the sequence.
12592
12593 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
12594 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
12595 do.
12596
12597 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
12598 unset-var or comment rules.
12599
12600 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012601 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
12602 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
12603 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
12604 option tcp-check
12605 tcp-check connect
12606 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12607 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12608 tcp-check send \r\n
12609 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12610 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
12611 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12612 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12613 tcp-check send \r\n
12614 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12615 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
12616
12617 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
12618 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012619 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012620 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12621 tcp-check connect port 143
12622 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12623 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
12624
12625 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
12626
12627
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012628tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012629 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012630 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012631 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012632 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012633 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012634 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012635
12636 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012637 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12638
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012639 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
12640 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
12641 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
12642 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
12643 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
12644 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
12645 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
12646 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
12647 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
12648 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
12649
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012650 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012651 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
12652 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012653 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
12654 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
12655 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
12656
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012657 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12658 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
12659 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012660 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
12661 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012662 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12663 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012664 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
12665 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012666 By default "L7OK" is used.
12667
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012668 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12669 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012670 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
12671 supported :
12672 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12673 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012674 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12675 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
12676 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12677 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
12678 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012679
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012680 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012681 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012682 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
12683 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12684 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12685 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012686 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
12687
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020012688 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12689 informational message reported in logs if the expect
12690 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
12691 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
12692
12693 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12694 informational message reported in logs if an error
12695 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
12696 log-format string.
12697
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012698 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
12699 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
12700 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12701 followed by some converters.
12702
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012703 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
12704 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
12705 with the usual backslash ('\').
12706 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012707 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012708 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
12709 used upper or lower case.
12710
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012711 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
12712
12713 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
12714 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12715 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
12716 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12717 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
12718 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
12719 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
12720 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
12721
12722 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
12723 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12724 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
12725 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12726 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
12727 expression.
12728
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012729 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
12730 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12731 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
12732 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
12733 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12734 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
12735
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012736 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
12737 in the response buffer. A health check response will
12738 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
12739 this exact hexadecimal string.
12740 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
12741
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012742 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
12743 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
12744 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
12745 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
12746 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
12747 size of the original response. As such, the expected
12748 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
12749 size.
12750
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012751 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
12752 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
12753 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
12754 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
12755 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
12756 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12757 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
12758 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
12759 in a binary string before matching the response's
12760 buffer.
12761
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012762 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012763 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012764 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
12765 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
12766 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
12767 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
12768 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
12769 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
12770 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
12771 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
12772 the null character.
12773
12774 Examples :
12775 # perform a POP check
12776 option tcp-check
12777 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12778
12779 # perform an IMAP check
12780 option tcp-check
12781 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12782
12783 # look for the redis master server
12784 option tcp-check
12785 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020012786 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012787 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12788 tcp-check expect string role:master
12789 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
12790 tcp-check expect string +OK
12791
12792
12793 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012794 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012795
12796
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012797tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
12798tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
12799 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
12800 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012801 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012802 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012803
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012804 Arguments :
12805 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12806
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012807 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
12808 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012809
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012810 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
12811 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012812
12813 Examples :
12814 # look for the redis master server
12815 option tcp-check
12816 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12817 tcp-check expect string role:master
12818
12819 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012820 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012821
12822
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012823tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
12824tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
12825 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
12826 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012827 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012828 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012829
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012830 Arguments :
12831 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012832
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012833 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
12834 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012835
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012836 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
12837 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
12838 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012839
12840 Examples :
12841 # redis check in binary
12842 option tcp-check
12843 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
12844 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
12845
12846
12847 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012848 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012849
12850
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012851tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12852tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012853 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012854 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012855 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012856
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012857 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012858 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12859 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12860 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12861 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12862 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12863 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12864 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12865 and '-'.
12866
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012867 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
12868 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050012869 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012870 conditions.
12871
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012872 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12873
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012874 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12875 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12876
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012877 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012878 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012879 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012880
12881
12882tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012883 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012884 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012885 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012886
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012887 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012888 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12889 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12890 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12891 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12892 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12893 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12894 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12895 and '-'.
12896
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012897 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012898 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12899
12900
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012901tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012902 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012904 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012905 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012906 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12907 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012908
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012909 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012910
12911 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12912 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012913 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12914 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12915 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12916 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12917 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12918 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012919
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012920 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12921 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12922 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012923 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
12924 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
12925 is true.
12926
12927 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12928 supported:
12929 - accept
12930 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12931 - expect-proxy layer4
12932 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010012933 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012934 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12935 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12936 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12937 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12938 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12939 - set-dst <expr>
12940 - set-dst-port <expr>
12941 - set-mark <mark>
12942 - set-src <expr>
12943 - set-src-port <expr>
12944 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012945 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12946 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010012947 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012948 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12949 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12950 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012951 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012952
12953 The supported actions are described below.
12954
12955 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
12956 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012957
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012958 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12959 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12960 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12961 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12962 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12963 a defaults section defining such rules.
12964
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012965 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12966 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12967 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012968
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012969 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12970 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12971 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012972
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012973 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12974 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
12975 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012976
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012977 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12978 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12979 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012980
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012981 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12982 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12983 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012984
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012985 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012986
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012987 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012988
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012989 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012990
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012991 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012992
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012993tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012994
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012995 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12996 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012997
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012998tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12999 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013000
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013001 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
13002 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
13003 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
13004 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
13005 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
13006 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
13007 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013008
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013009tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013010
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013011 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
13012 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
13013 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
13014 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
13015 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
13016 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013017
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013018tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013019
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013020 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
13021 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
13022 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
13023 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
13024 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
13025 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
13026 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
13027 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
13028 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
13029 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
13030 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013031
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013032tcp-request connection sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13033 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13034
13035 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13036 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13037 a complete description.
13038
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013039tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13040tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13041tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013042
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013043 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13044 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13045 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13046 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013047
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013048tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13049 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13050tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13051 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013052
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013053 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13054 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13055 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013056
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013057tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13058tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013059
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013060 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13061 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13062 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013063
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013064tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013065
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013066 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13067 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13068 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013069
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013070tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13071tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013072
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013073 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13074 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13075 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013076
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013077tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013078
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013079 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13080 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13081 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013082
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013083tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13084tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013085
13086 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13087 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
13088 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13089 for a complete description.
13090
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013091tcp-request connection silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013092
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013093 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13094 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13095 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13096 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013097
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013098tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13099tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13100tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013101
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013102 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13103 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13104 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013105
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013106tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13107
13108 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13109 details about variables.
13110
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013111
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013112tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13113 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013115 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013116 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013117 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13118 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013119
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013120 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013122 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013123 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13124 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013125 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
13126 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013127
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013128 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
13129 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
13130 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
13131 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013132 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013133 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013134 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
13135 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
13136 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
13137 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013138 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013139 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013140
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013141 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13142 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13143 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13144 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013145
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013146 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13147 supported:
13148 - accept
13149 - capture <sample> len <length>
13150 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13151 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013152 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013153 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013154 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013155 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013156 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010013157 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013158 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013159 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020013160 - set-dst <expr>
13161 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013162 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013163 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013164 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013165 - set-priority-class <expr>
13166 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013167 - set-src <expr>
13168 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013169 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013170 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13171 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013172 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013173 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013174 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13175 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13176 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013177 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013178 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013179
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013180 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013181
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013182 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
13183 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
13184 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
13185 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
13186 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
13187 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013188
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013189 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13190 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13191 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13192 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13193 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13194 a defaults section defining such rules.
13195
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013196 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013197 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13198 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013199
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020013200 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
13201 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
13202 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
13203 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
13204 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
13205 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
13206
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013207 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020013208 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
13209 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
13210 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
13211 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
13212 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
13213 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
13214 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
13215 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
13216 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
13217 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013218
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013219 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013220 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
13221 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
13222 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013223
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013224 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONd49b5592022-10-05 18:09:33 +020013225 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013226
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013227 Example:
13228
13229 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013230 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013231 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013232
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013233 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013234 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013235 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013236 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13237 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020013238 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013239 tcp-request content reject
13240
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013241 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
13242 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
13243 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13244 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13245 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
13246 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
13247 ...
13248 http-request reject unless is_host_com
13249
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013250 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013251 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
13252 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013253 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013254 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013255
13256 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
13257 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013258 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013259 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013260 tcp-request content reject
13261
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013262 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013263 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013264 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013265 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013266 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
13267 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013268
13269 Example:
13270 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13271 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013272 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013273
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013274 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013275 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013276
13277 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013278 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013279 # protecting all our sites
13280 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013281 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13282 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013283 ...
13284 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
13285
13286 backend http_dynamic
13287 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013288 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013289 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013290 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013291 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013292 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013293 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013294
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013295 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013296
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030013297 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
13298 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013299
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013300tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13301
13302 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010013303 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013304
13305tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
13306 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13307
13308 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
13309 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
13310 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
13311 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
13312 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
13313 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
13314 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
13315 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
13316 information.
13317
13318tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13319
13320 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
13321 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
13322 complete description.
13323
13324tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13325
13326 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
13327 are evaluated.
13328
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013329tcp-request content sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13330 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13331
13332 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13333 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13334 a complete description.
13335
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013336tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13337tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13338tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13339
13340 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13341 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13342 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13343 description.
13344
13345tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13346 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13347tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13348 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13349
13350 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13351 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13352 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
13353
13354tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13355 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13356
13357 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13358 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
13359
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013360tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
13361 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013362
13363 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13364 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13365 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13366
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013367tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13368tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13369
13370 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13371 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13372 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13373
13374tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13375
13376 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13377 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
13378
13379tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13380
13381 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13382 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13383 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13384
13385tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13386
13387 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13388 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
13389
13390tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13391
13392 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
13393 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
13394
13395tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13396
13397 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
13398 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
13399 description.
13400
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013401tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13402tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13403
13404 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13405 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13406 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13407
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013408tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13409
13410 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13411 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13412 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13413
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013414tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13415tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013416
13417 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13418 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13419 for a complete description.
13420
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013421tcp-request content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013422
13423 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13424 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13425 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13426 complete description.
13427
13428tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
13429 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13430
13431 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
13432 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
13433 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
13434 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
13435 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
13436 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
13437 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
13438 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
13439 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
13440 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
13441
13442 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
13443
13444tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13445tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13446tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13447
13448 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13449 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13450 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13451
13452tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13453
13454 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13455 details about variables.
13456
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020013457tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013458
13459 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
13460 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
13461 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
13462 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
13463 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
13464
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013465
13466tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
13467 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
13468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013469 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013470 Arguments :
13471 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13472 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13473 as explained at the top of this document.
13474
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013475 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013476 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
13477 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
13478 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
13479 data for at most the specified amount of time.
13480
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020013481 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
13482 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
13483 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
13484 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
13485
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013486 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013487 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013488 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013489 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013490 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010013491 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
13492 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
13493 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013494
13495 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
13496 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
13497 it pass through unaffected.
13498
13499 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
13500 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
13501 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013502 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013503 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
13504 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020013505 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
13506 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
13507 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013508
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013509 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13510 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13511
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013512 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013513 "timeout client".
13514
13515
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013516tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13517 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
13518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013519 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013520 Arguments :
13521 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13522 below.
13523
13524 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13525
13526 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
13527 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
13528 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
13529 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053013530 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013531 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
13532 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
13533 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
13534 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
13535 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
13536 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
13537 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
13538 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
13539 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
13540 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
13541 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
13542 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
13543 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
13544 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
13545 instead.
13546
13547 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13548 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13549 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
13550 rules which may be inserted.
13551
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013552 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13553 supported:
13554 - accept
13555 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013556 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013557 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13558 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13559 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13560 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13561 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013562 - set-dst <expr>
13563 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013564 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013565 - set-src <expr>
13566 - set-src-port <expr>
13567 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013568 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13569 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013570 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013571 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13572 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13573 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
13574 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013575
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013576 The supported actions are described below.
13577
13578 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13579 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13580 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13581 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13582 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13583 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013584
13585 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13586 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13587 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
13588
13589 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
13590 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
13591 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
13592 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
13593 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
13594
13595 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
13596 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13597
13598 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13599 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
13600 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
13601
13602 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13603 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
13604 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13605
13606 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
13607 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13608 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
13609
13610 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13611 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13612 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
13613
13614 See section 7 about ACL usage.
13615
13616 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
13617
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013618tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13619
13620 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
13621 rules are evaluated.
13622
13623tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13624
13625 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
13626 are evaluated.
13627
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013628tcp-request session sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13629 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13630
13631 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13632 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13633 a complete description.
13634
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013635tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13636tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13637tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13638
13639 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13640 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13641 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13642 description.
13643
13644tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13645 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13646tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13647 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13648
13649 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13650 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
13651 sc-inc-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete
13652 description.
13653
13654tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13655tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13656
13657 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13658 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13659 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13660
13661tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13662
13663 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13664 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13665 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13666
13667tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13668tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13669
13670 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13671 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13672 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13673
13674tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13675
13676 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13677 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13678 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13679
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013680tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13681tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013682
13683 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13684 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13685 for a complete description.
13686
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013687tcp-request session silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013688
13689 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13690 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13691 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13692 complete description.
13693
13694tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13695tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13696tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13697
13698 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13699 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13700 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13701
13702tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13703
13704 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13705 details about variables.
13706
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013707
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013708tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13709 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
13710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013711 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013712 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013713 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13714 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013715
13716 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13717
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013718 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013719 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13720 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013721 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
13722 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013723
13724 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
13725
13726 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13727 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13728 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13729 inserted.
13730
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013731 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13732 supported:
13733 - accept
13734 - close
13735 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013736 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013737 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13738 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13739 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13740 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13741 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13742 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013743 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013744 - set-log-level <level>
13745 - set-mark <mark>
13746 - set-nice <nice>
13747 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013748 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13749 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013750 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013751 - unset-var(<var-name>)
13752
13753 The supported actions are described below.
13754
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013755 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13756 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13757 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13758 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13759 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13760 a defaults section defining such rules.
13761
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013762 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13763 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13764 for changing the default action to a reject.
13765
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013766 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013767
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013768 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
13769 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
13770 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
13771 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
13772 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013773
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013774 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013775
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013776 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013777
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013778tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013779
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013780 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13781 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013782
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013783tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013784
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013785 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
13786 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
13787 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
13788 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
13789 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
13790 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013791
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013792tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013793
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013794 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13795 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013796
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013797tcp-response content sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13798 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13799
13800 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13801 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13802 a complete description.
13803
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013804tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13805tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13806tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013807
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013808 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13809 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13810 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13811 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013812
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013813tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13814 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13815tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13816 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013817
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013818 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13819 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13820 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013821
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013822tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13823 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013824
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013825 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13826 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013827
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013828
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013829tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
13830 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013831
13832 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13833 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13834 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13835
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013836tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013837
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013838 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13839 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013840
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013841tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013842
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013843 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13844 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13845 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013846
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013847tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013848
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013849 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13850 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013851
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013852tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013853
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013854 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13855 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13856 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013857
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013858tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13859tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013860
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013861 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13862 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13863 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013864
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013865tcp-response content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013866
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013867 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13868 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13869 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13870 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013871
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013872tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013873
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013874 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13875 details about variables.
13876
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013877
13878tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
13879 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
13880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013881 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013882 Arguments :
13883 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13884 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13885 as explained at the top of this document.
13886
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013887 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13888 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013889
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013890 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
13891
13892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013893timeout check <timeout>
13894 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
13895 established.
13896
13897 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13898 yes | no | yes | yes
13899 Arguments:
13900 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13901 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13902 as explained at the top of this document.
13903
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013904 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013905 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013906 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013907 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010013908 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
13909 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
13910 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013911
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013912 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013913 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
13914
13915 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
13916 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013917 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013918
13919 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13920 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13921 forget about it.
13922
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013923 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13924 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13925
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013926 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
13927 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013928
13929
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013930timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013931 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
13932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13933 yes | yes | yes | no
13934 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013935 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013936 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13937 as explained at the top of this document.
13938
13939 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13940 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13941 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010013942 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
13943 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
13944 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
13945 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013946 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
13947 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
13948 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013949 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013950 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013951 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
13952 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013953 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
13954 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013955
13956 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13957 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13958 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13959 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013960 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013961 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13962
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013963 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013964
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013965
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013966timeout client-fin <timeout>
13967 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
13968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13969 yes | yes | yes | no
13970 Arguments :
13971 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13972 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13973 as explained at the top of this document.
13974
13975 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13976 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13977 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13978 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13979 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
13980 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13981 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010013982 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
13983 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
13984 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013985
13986 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13987 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13988 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
13989
13990 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
13991
13992
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013993timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013994 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
13995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13996 yes | no | yes | yes
13997 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013998 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013999 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14000 as explained at the top of this document.
14001
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014002 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014003 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014004 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014005 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014006 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
14007 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014008
14009 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14010 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14011 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14012 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014013 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014014 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14015
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014016 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014017
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014018
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014019timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
14020 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
14021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14022 yes | yes | yes | yes
14023 Arguments :
14024 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14025 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14026 as explained at the top of this document.
14027
14028 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
14029 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
14030 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
14031 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
14032 once the request has started to present itself.
14033
14034 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
14035 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
14036 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
14037 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
14038 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
14039
14040 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
14041 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
14042 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
14043 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
14044
14045 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
14046 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014047 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014048 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
14049 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014050 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014051
14052 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
14053 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
14054 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
14055 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
14056
14057 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
14058
14059
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014060timeout http-request <timeout>
14061 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
14062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014063 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014064 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014065 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014066 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14067 as explained at the top of this document.
14068
14069 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
14070 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
14071 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
14072 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
14073 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
14074 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
14075 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014076 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
14077 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
14078 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
14079 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014080 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014081 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
14082 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014083
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014084 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
14085 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
14086 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
14087 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
14088 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014089 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014090
14091 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
14092 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014093 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014094 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
14095 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
14096
14097 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014098 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
14099 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
14100 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014101
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014102 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014103 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014104
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014105
14106timeout queue <timeout>
14107 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
14108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14109 yes | no | yes | yes
14110 Arguments :
14111 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14112 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14113 as explained at the top of this document.
14114
14115 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
14116 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
14117 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
14118 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
14119 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
14120
14121 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
14122 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
14123 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
14124 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
14125
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014126 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014127
14128
14129timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014130 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
14131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14132 yes | no | yes | yes
14133 Arguments :
14134 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14135 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14136 as explained at the top of this document.
14137
14138 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14139 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14140 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
14141 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
14142 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
14143 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
14144 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
14145
14146 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14147 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14148 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
14149 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
14150 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014151 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014152 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014153 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
14154 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014155 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
14156 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014157
14158 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14159 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14160 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14161 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014162 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014163 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14164
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014165 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014166
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014167
14168timeout server-fin <timeout>
14169 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
14170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14171 yes | no | yes | yes
14172 Arguments :
14173 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14174 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14175 as explained at the top of this document.
14176
14177 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14178 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14179 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14180 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14181 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
14182 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14183 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
14184 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
14185 situations, it should not be needed.
14186
14187 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14188 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14189 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
14190
14191 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
14192
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014193
14194timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014195 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14197 yes | yes | yes | yes
14198 Arguments :
14199 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
14200 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14201 as explained at the top of this document.
14202
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014203 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
14204 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
14205 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014206
14207 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14208 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14209 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
14210 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014211 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014212
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014213 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014214
14215
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014216timeout tunnel <timeout>
14217 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
14218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14219 yes | no | yes | yes
14220 Arguments :
14221 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14222 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14223 as explained at the top of this document.
14224
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014225 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014226 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
14227 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
14228 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014229 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
14230 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014231 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
14232 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
14233 specified.
14234
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014235 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
14236 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
14237 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
14238 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
14239 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
14240 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
14241 state.
14242
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014243 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14244 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14245 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
14246 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014247 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014248
14249 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14250 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14251 forget about it.
14252
14253 Example :
14254 defaults http
14255 option http-server-close
14256 timeout connect 5s
14257 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014258 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014259 timeout server 30s
14260 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
14261
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014262 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014263
14264
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014265transparent (deprecated)
14266 Enable client-side transparent proxying
14267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010014268 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014269 Arguments : none
14270
14271 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
14272 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
14273 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
14274 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
14275 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
14276 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
14277 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
14278 appropriate server.
14279
14280 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
14281
14282 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
14283 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
14284
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014285 See also: "option transparent"
14286
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014287unique-id-format <string>
14288 Generate a unique ID for each request.
14289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14290 yes | yes | yes | no
14291 Arguments :
14292 <string> is a log-format string.
14293
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014294 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
14295 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
14296 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
14297 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014298
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014299 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014300 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014301 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
14302 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
14303 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
14304 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
14305 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
14306 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014307
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014308 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
14309 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014310
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014311 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014312
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014313 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014314
14315 will generate:
14316
14317 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14318
14319 See also: "unique-id-header"
14320
14321unique-id-header <name>
14322 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
14323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14324 yes | yes | yes | no
14325 Arguments :
14326 <name> is the name of the header.
14327
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014328 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
14329 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014330
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014331 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014332
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014333 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014334 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
14335
14336 will generate:
14337
14338 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14339
14340 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014341
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014342use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014343 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14345 no | yes | yes | no
14346 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014347 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
14348 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014349
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014350 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
14351 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014352
14353 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
14354 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
14355 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014356 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014357 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014358 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
14359 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014360
14361 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
14362 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
14363 assign the backend.
14364
14365 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
14366 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14367 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
14368 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
14369 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
14370 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
14371
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014372 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014373 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014374 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
14375 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
14376 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
14377
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014378 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
14379 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
14380 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
14381 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
14382 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
14383 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
14384 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
14385 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
14386 cannot be forced from the request.
14387
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014388 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014389 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
14390 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
14391
14392 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
14393 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014394
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020014395use-fcgi-app <name>
14396 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
14397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14398 no | no | yes | yes
14399 Arguments :
14400 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
14401
14402 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014403
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014404use-server <server> if <condition>
14405use-server <server> unless <condition>
14406 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
14407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14408 no | no | yes | yes
14409 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014410 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
14411 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014412
14413 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
14414
14415 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
14416 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
14417 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
14418
14419 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
14420 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
14421 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
14422 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
14423 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
14424 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
14425 matches will assign the server.
14426
14427 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
14428 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
14429 with the next rules until one matches.
14430
14431 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
14432 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14433 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
14434 according to other persistence mechanisms.
14435
14436 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
14437 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
14438 stripped.
14439
14440 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
14441 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014442 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014443 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014444 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014445
14446 Example :
14447 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014448 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014449 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014450 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014451 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014452 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000014453 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014454 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
14455 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
14456
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014457 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
14458 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
14459 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
14460 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050014461 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014462 and we fall back to load balancing.
14463
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014464 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014465
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014466
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100144675. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014468--------------------------
14469
14470The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
14471depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
14472settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
14473written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
14474described in this section.
14475
14476
144775.1. Bind options
14478-----------------
14479
14480The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
14481as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
14482no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
14483parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
14484while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
14485provided immediately after the setting name.
14486
14487The currently supported settings are the following ones.
14488
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014489accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
14490 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
14491 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
14492 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
14493 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
14494 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
14495 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
14496 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
14497 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
14498 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010014499 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
14500 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
14501 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014502
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014503accept-proxy
14504 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020014505 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
14506 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014507 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
14508 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
14509 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
14510 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014511 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014512 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
14513 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020014514 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
14515 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014516
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014517allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010014518 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014519 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014520 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014521 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
14522 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014523
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014524alpn <protocols>
14525 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14526 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14527 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014528 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014529 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014530 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
14531 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14532 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
14533 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
14534 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
14535 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
14536 preference, like below :
14537
14538 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014539
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014540 QUIC supports only h3 and hq-interop as ALPN. h3 is for HTTP/3 and hq-interop
14541 is used for http/0.9 and QUIC interop runner (see https://interop.seemann.io).
14542
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014543backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010014544 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014545 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
14546
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010014547curves <curves>
14548 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14549 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
14550 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
14551 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
14552 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
14553 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
14554
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014555ecdhe <named curve>
14556 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010014557 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
14558 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014559
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014560ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014561 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14562 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014563 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14564 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020014565 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014566
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014567 Warning: The "@system-ca" parameter could be used in place of the cafile
14568 in order to use the trusted CAs of your system, like its done with the server
14569 directive. But you mustn't use it unless you know what you are doing.
14570 Configuring it this way basically mean that the bind will accept any client
14571 certificate generated from one of the CA present on your system, which is
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050014572 extremely insecure.
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014573
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014574ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
14575 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14576 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010014577 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
14578 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
14579 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
14580 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
14581 in new version of OpenSSL.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014582 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14583 error is ignored.
14584
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014585ca-sign-file <cafile>
14586 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14587 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
14588 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
14589 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14590 'generate-certificates' for details.
14591
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000014592ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014593 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
14594 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
14595 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14596 'generate-certificates' for details.
14597
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014598ca-verify-file <cafile>
14599 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
14600 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
14601 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
14602 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
14603 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
14604
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014605ciphers <ciphers>
14606 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14607 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000014608 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014609 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014610 information and recommendations see e.g.
14611 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14612 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14613 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
14614
14615ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14616 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14617 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
14618 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
14619 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014620 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
14621 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014622
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014623crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014624 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14625 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020014626 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
14627 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014628
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014629crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014630 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14631 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
14632 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
14633 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
14634 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010014635 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
14636 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014637
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010014638 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
14639 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
14640
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014641 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
14642 are loaded.
14643
14644 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010014645 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
William Lallemand589570d2022-05-09 10:30:51 +020014646 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). Files
14647 starting with a dot are also ignored. This directive may be specified multiple
14648 times in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
14649 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
14650 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
14651 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
14652 hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
14653 www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014654
14655 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
14656 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
14657 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
14658 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010014659 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
14660 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014661
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020014662 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014663
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014664 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014665 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014666 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
14667 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014668 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
14669 clients).
14670
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014671 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014672 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
14673 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
14674 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
14675 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
14676 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
14677 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
14678 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
14679 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
14680 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
14681 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
14682 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
14683 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
14684
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014685 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010014686 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
14687 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
14688 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
14689 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
14690
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050014691 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
14692 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
14693 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
14694 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014695
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014696 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
14697 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
14698 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014699
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014700crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014701 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010014702 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
14703 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
14704 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
14705 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
14706 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
14707 in new version of OpenSSL.
14708 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14709 error is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014710
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014711crt-list <file>
14712 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014713 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
14714 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014715
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014716 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
14717
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020014718 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
14719 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
14720 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
14721 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
14722 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014723
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014724 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014725 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
14726 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
14727 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
14728 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
14729 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014730 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
14731 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
14732 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014733
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014734 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
14735 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
14736 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014737
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014738 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
14739
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014740 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014741 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014742 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
14743 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
14744 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
14745 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
14746 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
14747 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014748
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014749 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014750 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014751 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014752 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014753 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014754 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014755
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014756defer-accept
14757 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14758 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
14759 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014760 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014761 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
14762 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
14763 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
14764 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
14765 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
14766 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
14767 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
14768
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014769expose-fd listeners
14770 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
14771 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010014772 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
14773 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014774 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014775
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014776force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014777 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014778 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014779 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014780 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014781
14782force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014783 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014784 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014785 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014786
14787force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014788 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014789 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014790 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014791
14792force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014793 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014794 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014795 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014796
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014797force-tlsv13
14798 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
14799 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014800 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014801
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014802generate-certificates
14803 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14804 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
14805 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
14806 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
14807 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
14808 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
14809 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
14810 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
14811 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
14812 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
14813 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
14814
14815 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
14816 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014817 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014818 certificate is used many times.
14819
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014820gid <gid>
14821 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
14822 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14823 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
14824 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
14825 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14826
14827group <group>
14828 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
14829 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
14830 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
14831 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
14832 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14833
14834id <id>
14835 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
14836 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
14837 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
14838 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
14839
14840interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010014841 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
14842 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
14843 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
14844 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
14845 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
14846 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010014847 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
14848 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
14849 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
14850 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
14851 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
14852 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014853
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014854level <level>
14855 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
14856 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
14857 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014858 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014859 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
14860 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
14861 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014862 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014863 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014864 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014865 all counters).
14866
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020014867severity-output <format>
14868 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
14869 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
14870 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
14871 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
14872 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
14873 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
14874 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
14875 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
14876 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
14877 rfc5424 convention.
14878
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014879maxconn <maxconn>
14880 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
14881 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
14882 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
14883 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
14884 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
14885 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
14886 eat all memory.
14887
14888mode <mode>
14889 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
14890 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
14891 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
14892 UNIX sockets.
14893
14894mss <maxseg>
14895 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
14896 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
14897 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
14898 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
14899 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
14900 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
14901 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
14902 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
14903 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
14904 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
14905 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
14906
14907name <name>
14908 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
14909 page.
14910
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014911namespace <name>
14912 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14913 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
14914 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14915 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14916
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014917nice <nice>
14918 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
14919 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
14920 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
14921 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
14922 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
14923 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
14924 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
14925 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
14926 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
14927 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
14928 one for an RDP socket.
14929
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014930no-ca-names
14931 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14932 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014933 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014934
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014935no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014936 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014937 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014938 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014939 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014940 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
14941 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014942
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014943no-tls-tickets
14944 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14945 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14946 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014947 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
14948 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014949 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14950 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14951 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014952
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014953no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014954 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014955 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014956 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014957 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014958 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14959 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014960
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014961no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014962 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014963 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014964 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014965 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014966 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14967 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014968
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014969no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014970 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014971 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014972 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014973 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014974 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14975 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014976
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014977no-tlsv13
14978 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14979 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
14980 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
14981 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014982 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14983 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014984
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014985npn <protocols>
14986 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14987 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14988 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014989 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014990 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014991 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14992 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
14993 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
14994 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
14995 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014996
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010014997ocsp-update [ off | on ]
14998 Enable automatic OCSP response update when set to 'on', disable it otherwise.
14999 Its value defaults to 'off'.
15000 This option can only be used in a crt-list line so that is applies to only
15001 one certificate at a time. If a given certificate is used in multiple
15002 crt-lists with different values of the 'ocsp-update' set, an error will be
15003 raised.
15004 When the option is set to 'on', we will try to get an ocsp response whenever
15005 an ocsp uri is found in the frontend's certificate. The only limitation of
15006 this mode is that the certificate's issuer will have to be known in order for
15007 the OCSP certid to be built.
15008 Each OCSP response will be updated at least once an hour, and even more
15009 frequently if a given OCSP response has an expire date earlier than this one
15010 hour limit. A minimum update interval of 5 minutes will still exist in order
15011 to avoid updating too often responses that have a really short expire time or
15012 even no 'Next Update' at all. Because of this hard limit, please note that
15013 when auto update is set to 'on' or 'auto', any OCSP response loaded during
15014 init will not be updated until at least 5 minutes, even if its expire time
15015 ends before now+5m. This should not be too much of a hassle since an OCSP
15016 response must be valid when it gets loaded during init (its expire time must
15017 be in the future) so it is unlikely that this response expires in such a
15018 short time after init.
15019 On the other hand, if a certificate has an OCSP uri specified and no OCSP
15020 response, setting this option to 'on' for the given certificate will ensure
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +010015021 that the OCSP response gets fetched automatically right after init. The
15022 default minimum and maximum delays (5 minutes and 1 hour respectively) can be
15023 configured by the "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay" and
15024 "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay" global options.
15025
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015026 Whenever an OCSP response is updated by the auto update task or following a
15027 call to the "update ssl ocsp-response" CLI command, a dedicated log line is
15028 emitted. It follows a dedicated log-format that contains the following header
15029 "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft" and is followed by specific OCSP-related information:
15030 - the path of the corresponding frontend certificate
15031 - a numerical update status
15032 - a textual update status
15033 - the number of update failures for the given response
15034 - the number of update successes for the givan response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb33fe2f2023-02-28 17:46:25 +010015035 See "show ssl ocsp-updates" CLI command for a full list of error codes and
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015036 error messages. This line is emitted regardless of the success or failure of
15037 the concerned OCSP response update.
15038 The OCSP request/response is sent and received through an http_client
15039 instance that has the dontlog-normal option set and that uses the regular
15040 HTTP log format in case of error (unreachable OCSP responder for instance).
15041 If such an error occurs, another log line that contains HTTP-related
15042 information will then be emitted alongside the "regular" OCSP one (which will
15043 likely have "HTTP error" as text status).
15044
15045 but if a purely HTTP error happens
15046 (unreachable OCSP responder for instance), an extra log line that follows the
15047 regular HTTP log-format will be emitted.
15048 Here are two examples of such log lines, with a successful OCSP update log line first
15049 and then an example of an HTTP error with the two different lines:
15050 <134>Mar 6 11:16:53 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:16:52.808] <OCSP-UPDATE> /path_to_cert/foo.pem 1 "Update successful" 0 1
15051
15052 <134>Mar 6 11:18:55 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:18:54.207] <OCSP-UPDATE> /path_to_cert/bar.pem 2 "HTTP error" 1 0
15053 <134>Mar 6 11:18:55 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:18:52.200] <OCSP-UPDATE> -/- 2/0/-1/-1/3009 503 217 - - SC-- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0 {} "GET http://127.0.0.1:12345/MEMwQTA%2FMD0wOzAJBgUrDgMCGgUABBSKg%2BAGD6%2F3Ccp%2Bm5VSKi6BY1%2FaCgQU9lKw5DXV6pI4UVCPCtvpLYXeAHoCAhAV HTTP/1.1"
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015054
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000015055prefer-client-ciphers
15056 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
15057 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
15058 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020015059 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
15060 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
15061 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000015062
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015063proto <name>
15064 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
15065 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
15066 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015067 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
15068 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15069
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015070 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15071 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15072 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015073
15074 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15075 a bind line :
15076
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015077 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015078 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15079 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15080
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015081 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015082 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080015083 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015084 h2" on the bind line.
15085
Frédéric Lécaille43910a92022-07-11 10:24:21 +020015086quic-cc-algo [ cubic | newreno ]
15087 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
15088
15089 This is a QUIC specific setting to select the congestion control algorithm
15090 for any connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. They are similar
15091 to those used by TCP.
15092
15093 Default value: cubic
15094
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015095quic-force-retry
15096 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
15097 change without deprecation in the future.
15098
15099 This is a QUIC specific setting which forces the use of the QUIC Retry feature
15100 for all the connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. It consists
15101 in veryfying the peers are able to receive packets at the transport address
15102 they used to initiate a new connection, sending them a Retry packet which
15103 contains a token. This token must be sent back to the Retry packet sender,
15104 this latter being the only one to be able to validate the token. Note that QUIC
15105 Retry will always be used even if a Retry threshold was set (see
Amaury Denoyelle996ca7d2022-11-14 16:17:13 +010015106 "tune.quic.retry-threshold" setting).
15107
15108 This setting requires the cluster secret to be set or else an error will be
15109 reported on startup (see "cluster-secret").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015110
15111 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
15112 information about QUIC retry.
15113
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020015114shards <number> | by-thread
15115 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
15116 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
15117 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
15118 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
15119 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
15120 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
15121 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
15122 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
15123 little bit.
15124
15125 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
15126 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
15127 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
15128 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
15129 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
15130 is an integral divisor of the number of threads.
15131
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015132ssl
15133 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015134 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015135 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
15136 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020015137 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
15138 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015139
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015140ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15141 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015142 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
15143 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
15144 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015145 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15146
15147ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015148 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
15149 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
15150 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
15151 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015152
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015153strict-sni
15154 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
15155 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
15156 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
15157 See the "crt" option for more information.
15158
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015159tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015160 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015161 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015162 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015163 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015164 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
15165 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
15166 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
15167 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
15168 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
15169 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
15170 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15171
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015172tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010015173 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015174 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
15175 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
15176 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
15177 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
15178 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
15179 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
15180 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020015181 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
15182 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
15183 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015184
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015185thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>[,...]
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015186 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
15187 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
15188 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015189
15190 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
15191 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015192 It is also possible to designate a thread number using its relative number
15193 inside its thread group, by specifying the thread group number first, then a
15194 slash ('/') and the relative thread number(s). In this case thread numbers
15195 also start at 1 and end at 32 or 64 depending on the platform. When absolute
15196 thread numbers are specified, they will be automatically translated to
15197 relative numbers once thread groups are known. Usually, absolute numbers are
15198 preferred for simple configurations, and relative ones are preferred for
15199 complex configurations where CPU arrangement matters for performance.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015200
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015201 After the optional thread group number, the "thread-set" specification must
15202 use the following format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015203
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015204 "all" | "odd" | "even" | [number][-[number]]
15205
15206 As their names imply, "all" validates all threads within the set (either all
15207 of the group's when a group is specified, or all of the process' threads),
15208 "odd" validates all odd-numberred threads (every other thread starting at 1)
15209 either for the process or the group, and "even" validates all even-numberred
15210 threads (every other thread starting at 2). If instead thread number ranges
15211 are used, then all threads included in the range from the first to the last
15212 thread number are validated. The numbers are either relative to the group
Willy Tarreau7fd87562023-02-28 08:19:37 +010015213 or absolute depending on the presence of a thread group number. If the first
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015214 thread number is omitted, "1" is used, representing either the first thread
15215 of the group or the first thread of the process. If the last thread number is
15216 omitted, either the last thread number of the group (32 or 64) is used, or
15217 the last thread number of the process (global.nbthread).
15218
15219 These ranges may be repeated and delimited by a comma, so that non-contiguous
15220 thread sets can be specified, and the group, if present, must be specified
15221 again for each new range. Note that it is not permitted to mix group-relative
15222 and absolute specifications because the whole "bind" line must use either
15223 an absolute notation or a relative one, as those not set will be resolved at
15224 the end of the parsing.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015225
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015226 The main purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but
15227 not the same thread in a listener, so that the system can distribute the
15228 incoming connections into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue
15229 load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015230
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015231tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
15232 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010015233 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
15234 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
15235 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
15236 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
15237 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
15238 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
15239 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
15240 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
15241 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
15242 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015243 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
15244 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
15245
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015246transparent
15247 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15248 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
15249 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
15250 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
15251 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
15252 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
15253 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
15254 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
15255 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
15256 so check for support with your vendor.
15257
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015258v4v6
15259 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15260 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
15261 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
15262 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015263 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015264
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015265v6only
15266 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15267 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
15268 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015269 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
15270 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015271
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015272uid <uid>
15273 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
15274 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15275 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
15276 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
15277 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15278
15279user <user>
15280 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
15281 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15282 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
15283 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
15284 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15285
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015286verify [none|optional|required]
15287 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
15288 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
15289 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
15290 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
15291 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020015292 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
15293 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
15294 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
15295 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020015296
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200152975.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015298------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015299
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015300The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
15301which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
15302arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
15303settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
15304after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
15305Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
15306address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015308 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015309 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015310
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015311Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
15312keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
15313
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015314The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015315
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015316addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015317 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010015318 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15319 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
15320 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
15321 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
15322 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015323
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015324agent-check
15325 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015326 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010015327 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
15328 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
15329 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015330
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015331 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015332 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015333 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020015334 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
15335 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015336
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015337 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
15338 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
15339 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
15340 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
15341 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020015342
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015343 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015344 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015345
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015346 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15347 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
15348 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015349
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015350 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15351 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
15352 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015353
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020015354 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015355 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
15356 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
15357 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
15358 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015359 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015360 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015361
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015362 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
15363 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015364
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015365 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
15366 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
15367 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
15368 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
15369 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
15370 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
15371 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
15372 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
15373 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015374
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015375 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
15376 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015377 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
15378 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
15379 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010015380 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015381
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015382 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015383 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015384
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015385agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015386 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015387 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
15388 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
15389 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
15390 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
15391
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015392agent-inter <delay>
15393 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
15394 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15395
15396 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
15397 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
15398 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
15399 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
15400 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15401 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15402 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15403 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15404 of backends use the same servers.
15405
15406 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
15407
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015408agent-addr <addr>
15409 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
15410
15411 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015412 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015413 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
15414 hostname, it will be resolved.
15415
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015416agent-port <port>
15417 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
15418
15419 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
15420
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015421allow-0rtt
15422 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020015423 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
15424 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015425
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015426alpn <protocols>
15427 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
15428 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
15429 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015430 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015431 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
15432 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
15433 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
15434 now obsolete NPN extension.
15435 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
15436 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
15437
15438 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
15439
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015440 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
15441
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015442backup
15443 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
15444 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
15445 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
15446 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015447 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
15448 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015449
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015450ca-file <cafile>
15451 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15452 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015453 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
15454 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020015455 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015456
15457 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
15458 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
15459 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015460
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015461check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015462 This option enables health checks on a server:
15463 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
15464 considered available.
15465 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
15466 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
15467 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
15468 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
15469 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015470 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
15471 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015472 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
15473 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
15474 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
15475 exchanges succeed.
15476
15477 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
15478 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
15479 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
15480 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
15481 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050015482 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015483 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
15484
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015485 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +020015486 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitly
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015487 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
15488 not overridden.
15489
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015490 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
15491 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
15492
15493 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
15494 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
15495
15496 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
15497 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
15498 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
15499 available.
15500
15501 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
15502 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
15503 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
15504
15505 Example:
15506 # simple tcp check
15507 backend foo
15508 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
15509 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
15510 backend foo
15511 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
15512 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
15513 backend foo
15514 option tcp-check
15515 tcp-check connect
15516 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015517
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020015518check-send-proxy
15519 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
15520 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
15521 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
15522 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
15523 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
15524 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
15525 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
15526
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010015527check-alpn <protocols>
15528 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
15529 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
15530 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
15531
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015532check-proto <name>
15533 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
15534 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
15535 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015536 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
15537 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15538
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015539 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15540 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15541 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015542
15543 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
15544 directive on a server line:
15545
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015546 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015547 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15548 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15549 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15550
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015551 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015552 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
15553 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
15554
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015555check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015556 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015557 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
15558 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015559
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015560check-ssl
15561 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
15562 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
15563 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
15564 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015565 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015566 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
15567 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015568 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015569 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
15570 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015571
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015572check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015573 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015574 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
15575 for normal traffic.
15576
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015577ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015578 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
15579 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
15580 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015581 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
15582 information and recommendations see e.g.
15583 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
15584 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
15585 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015586
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015587ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
15588 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
15589 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
15590 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
15591 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015592 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
15593 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
15594 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015595
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015596cookie <value>
15597 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
15598 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
15599 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
15600 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
15601 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
15602 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
15603 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
15604
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015605crl-file <crlfile>
15606 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15607 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
15608 to verify server's certificate.
15609
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020015610crt <cert>
15611 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
15612 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
15613 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
15614 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
15615 certificate request.
15616
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020015617 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
15618 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
15619 option is set accordingly).
15620
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015621disabled
15622 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
15623 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
15624 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
15625 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
15626 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015627 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015628
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015629enabled
15630 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
15631 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
15632 default value.
15633 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
15634 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015636error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010015637 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
15638 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
15639 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015640
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015641 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015642
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015643fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015644 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
15645 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
15646 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
15647
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015648force-sslv3
15649 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
15650 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015651 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015652 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015653
15654force-tlsv10
15655 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015656 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015657 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015658
15659force-tlsv11
15660 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015661 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015662 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015663
15664force-tlsv12
15665 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015666 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015667 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015668
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015669force-tlsv13
15670 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
15671 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015672 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015673
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015674id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020015675 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
15676 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
15677 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015678
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015679init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
15680 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
15681 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015682 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015683 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
15684 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
15685 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
15686 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
15687 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
15688 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
15689 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
15690 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
15691 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015692 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015693 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
15694 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
15695 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
15696 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
15697 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
15698 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015699 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015700
15701 Example:
15702 defaults
15703 # never fail on address resolution
15704 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
15705
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015706inter <delay>
15707fastinter <delay>
15708downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015709 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
15710 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15711 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
15712 between checks depending on the server state :
15713
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020015714 Server state | Interval used
15715 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15716 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
15717 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15718 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
15719 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
15720 or yet unchecked. |
15721 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15722 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
15723 | "inter" otherwise.
15724 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015725
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015726 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
15727 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
15728 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
15729 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015730 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15731 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15732 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15733 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15734 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015735
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020015736log-proto <logproto>
15737 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
15738 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
15739 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
15740 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
15741
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015742maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015743 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
15744 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010015745 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
15746 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015747 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
15748 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
15749 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
15750 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
15751
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010015752 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
15753 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
15754 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
15755 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
15756 than 50 concurrent requests.
15757
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015758maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015759 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
15760 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
15761 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
15762 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020015763 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
15764 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
15765 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
15766 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
15767 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
15768 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
15769 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015770
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010015771max-reuse <count>
15772 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
15773 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
15774 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
15775 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
15776 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
15777 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
15778 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
15779 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
15780
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015781minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015782 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
15783 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
15784 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
15785 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
15786 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
15787 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015788 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015789 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015790
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020015791namespace <name>
15792 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
15793 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
15794 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
15795 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
15796
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015797no-agent-check
15798 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
15799 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15800 default value.
15801 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15802 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
15803
15804no-backup
15805 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
15806 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15807 default value.
15808 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15809 "default-server" "backup" setting.
15810
15811no-check
15812 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
15813 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15814 default value.
15815 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15816 "default-server" "check" setting.
15817
15818no-check-ssl
15819 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
15820 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15821 default value.
15822 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15823 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
15824
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015825no-send-proxy
15826 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
15827 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15828 default value.
15829 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15830 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
15831
15832no-send-proxy-v2
15833 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
15834 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15835 default value.
15836 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15837 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
15838
15839no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
15840 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
15841 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15842 default value.
15843 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15844 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
15845
15846no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15847 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
15848 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15849 default value.
15850 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15851 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
15852
15853no-ssl
15854 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
15855 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15856 default value.
15857 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15858 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
15859
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010015860 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
15861 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
15862 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
15863
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010015864no-ssl-reuse
15865 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
15866 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
15867 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
15868 and for paranoid users.
15869
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015870no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015871 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15872 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015873 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015874
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015875 Supported in default-server: No
15876
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015877no-tls-tickets
15878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15879 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
15880 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015881 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
15882 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015883 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15884 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15885 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015886 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015887
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015888no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015889 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015890 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15891 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015892 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15893 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015894 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015895
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015896 Supported in default-server: No
15897
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015898no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015899 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015900 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15901 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015902 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15903 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015904 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015905
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015906 Supported in default-server: No
15907
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015908no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015909 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015910 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15911 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015912 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15913 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015914 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015915
15916 Supported in default-server: No
15917
15918no-tlsv13
15919 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15920 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15921 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
15922 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15923 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015924 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015925
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015926 Supported in default-server: No
15927
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015928no-verifyhost
15929 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
15930 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15931 default value.
15932 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15933 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015934
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015935no-tfo
15936 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
15937 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15938 default value.
15939 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15940 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
15941
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090015942non-stick
15943 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
15944 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
15945 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
15946
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015947npn <protocols>
15948 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15949 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15950 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015951 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015952 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
15953 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15954 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
15955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015956observe <mode>
15957 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
15958 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
15959 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
15960 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
15961 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
15962 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010015963 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015964
15965 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
15966
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015967on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015968 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
15969 Currently, four modes are available:
15970 - fastinter: force fastinter
15971 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
15972 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
15973 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
15974 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
15975
15976 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
15977
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015978on-marked-down <action>
15979 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
15980 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015981 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
15982 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
15983 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
15984 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
15985 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
15986 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
15987 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
15988 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015989
15990 Actions are disabled by default
15991
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015992on-marked-up <action>
15993 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
15994 Currently one action is available:
15995 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
15996 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
15997 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
15998 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015999 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
16000 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016001 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
16002 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
16003
16004 Actions are disabled by default
16005
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020016006pool-low-conn <max>
16007 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
16008 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
16009 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
16010 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
16011 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
16012 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
16013 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
16014 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
16015 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
16016 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010016017 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
16018 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
16019 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
16020 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020016021
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010016022pool-max-conn <max>
16023 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
16024 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
16025 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
16026 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
16027 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
16028 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
16029
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010016030pool-purge-delay <delay>
16031 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010016032 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020016033 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010016034
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016035port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016036 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010016037 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
16038 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
16039 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
16040 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
16041 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016042
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016043proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016044 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
16045 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
16046 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016047 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
16048 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
16049
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016050 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
16051 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
16052 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016053
16054 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
16055 a server line :
16056
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016057 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016058 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
16059 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
16060 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
16061
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016062 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016063 protocol for all connections established to this server.
16064
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016065 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
16066
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016067redir <prefix>
16068 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
16069 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
16070 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
16071 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
16072 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
16073 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
16074 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
16075 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016076 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016077 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016078 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
16079 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
16080 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
16081 loop between the client and HAProxy!
16082
16083 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
16084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016085rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016086 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
16087 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
16088 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
16089
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016090resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
16091 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
16092 server.
16093
16094 Available options:
16095
16096 * allow-dup-ip
16097 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
16098 resolution at runtime is in operation.
16099 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
16100 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
16101 For such case, simply enable this option.
16102 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
16103
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050016104 * ignore-weight
16105 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
16106 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
16107 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
16108
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016109 * prevent-dup-ip
16110 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
16111 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
16112 same fqdn.
16113 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
16114
16115 Example:
16116 backend b_myapp
16117 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
16118 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16119 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16120
16121 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
16122 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
16123 it
16124 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
16125 different address
16126
16127 Default value: not set
16128
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016129resolve-prefer <family>
16130 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
16131 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
16132 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
16133 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
16134
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020016135 Default value: ipv6
16136
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016137 Example:
16138
16139 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016140
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016141resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016142 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016143 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016144 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016145 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
16146 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016147 configured network, another address is selected.
16148
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016149 Example:
16150
16151 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016152
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016153resolvers <id>
16154 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
16155 hostname.
16156
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016157 Example:
16158
16159 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016160
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016161 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016162
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016163send-proxy
16164 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
16165 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
16166 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
16167 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016168 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
16169 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
16170 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
16171 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016172 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016173 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
16174 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
16175 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
16176 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
16177 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016178 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
16179 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016180
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016181send-proxy-v2
16182 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
16183 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16184 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16185 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020016186 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
16187 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
16188 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
16189 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016190
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016191proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010016192 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
16193 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
16194
16195 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
16196 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
16197 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
16198 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
16199 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
16200 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
16201 connection is supported).
16202 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
16203 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
16204 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
16205 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
16206 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
16207 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
16208 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016209
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016210send-proxy-v2-ssl
16211 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16212 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16213 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16214 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16215 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16216 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
16217 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016218 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
16219 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016220
16221send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16222 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16223 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16224 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16225 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16226 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16227 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
16228 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
16229 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016230 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
16231 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016232
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +020016233shard <shard>
16234 This parameter in used only in the context of stick-tables synchronisation
16235 with peers protocol. The "shard" parameter identifies the peers which will
16236 receive all the stick-table updates for keys with this shard as distribution
16237 hash. The accepted values are 0 up to "shards" parameter value specified in
16238 the "peers" section. 0 value is the default value meaning that the peer will
16239 receive all the key updates. Greater values than "shards" will be ignored.
16240 This is also the case for any value provided to the local peer.
16241
16242 Example :
16243
16244 peers mypeers
16245 shards 3
16246 peer A 127.0.0.1:40001 # local peer without shard value (0 internally)
16247 peer B 127.0.0.1:40002 shard 1
16248 peer C 127.0.0.1:40003 shard 2
16249 peer D 127.0.0.1:40004 shard 3
16250
16251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016252slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016253 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
16254 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
16255 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
16256 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
16257 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
16258 parameters :
16259
16260 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
16261 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
16262
16263 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
16264 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
16265 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
16266 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
16267
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016268 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016269 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
16270 seen as failed.
16271
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016272sni <expression>
16273 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
16274 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
16275 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010016276 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
16277 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
16278 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
16279 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020016280 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016281 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010016282 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
16283 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016284
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016285source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020016286source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016287source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016288 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
16289 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
16290 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
16291 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
16292
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016293 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
16294 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
16295 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
16296 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
16297 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
16298 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
16299 server.
16300
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000016301 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
16302 specifying the source address without port(s).
16303
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016304ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020016305 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
16306 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
16307 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
16308 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
16309 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
16310 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016311 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
16312 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016313
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016314ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16315 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
16316 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16317 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
16318
16319ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16320 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
16321 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16322 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
16323
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016324ssl-reuse
16325 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
16326 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16327 default value.
16328 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16329 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
16330
16331stick
16332 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
16333 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16334 default value.
16335 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16336 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016337
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016338socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016339 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016340 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
16341 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
16342
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016343tcp-ut <delay>
16344 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016345 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016346 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016347 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016348 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
16349 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
16350 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
16351 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
16352 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
16353 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
16354 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
16355 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
16356 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
16357
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016358tfo
16359 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
16360 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
16361 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
16362 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016363 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016364 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016366track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020016367 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
16368 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
16369 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
16370 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016371 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
16372
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016373tls-tickets
16374 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
16375 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16376 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016377 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16378 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16379 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016380 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010016381 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016382
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016383verify [none|required]
16384 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010016385 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016386 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
16387 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016388 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016389 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
16390 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
16391 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
16392 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
16393 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
16394 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
16395 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
16396 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016397
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016398verifyhost <hostname>
16399 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016400 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
16401 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
16402 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
16403 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
16404 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
16405 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
16406 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
16407 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016408
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016409weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016410 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
16411 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
16412 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020016413 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
16414 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
16415 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
16416 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
16417 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
16418 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016419
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016420ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
16421 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
16422 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
16423 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
16424
16425 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
16426 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
16427 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
16428 server ALPN contains it.
16429
16430 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
16431 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
16432 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
16433 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
16434
16435 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
16436 favor of the ALPN extension.
16437
16438 See also "alpn" and "proto".
16439
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016440
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200164415.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
16442-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016443
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016444HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
16445using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070016446configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016447This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
16448can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
16449workload.
16450This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
16451resolution at run time.
16452Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
16453carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
16454
16455
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200164565.3.1. Global overview
16457----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016458
16459As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
16460different steps of the process life:
16461
16462 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
16463 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
16464 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
16465
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016466 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
16467 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016468
16469A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
16470 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
16471 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
16472 resolution to know this new IP.
16473
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016474When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016475HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016476SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
16477from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016478will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016479will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020016480
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016481A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016482 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016483 first valid response.
16484
16485 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
16486 servers return an error.
16487
16488
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200164895.3.2. The resolvers section
16490----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016491
16492This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016493HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
16494contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016495
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020016496At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
16497no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
16498default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
16499failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
16500
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016501When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
16502uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
16503is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
16504answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
16505
16506When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016507used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016508
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016509 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
16510 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
16511 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016512
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016513 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
16514 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016515
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010016516 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016517 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
16518 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016519
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016520For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
16521following scenarios are possible:
16522
16523 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
16524 ignored
16525
16526 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
16527 applied
16528
16529 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
16530 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
16531
16532 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
16533 retries the query with a new type
16534
16535 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
16536 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016537
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016538As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016539a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016540<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016541
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016542
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016543resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016544 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016545
16546A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
16547
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016548accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016549 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016550 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016551 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
16552 by RFC 6891)
16553
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010016554 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
16555 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
16556 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
16557 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
16558 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
16559 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020016560
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020016561nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
16562 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
16563 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
16564 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
16565 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
16566 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
16567 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
16568 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
16569 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
16570 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010016571 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
16572
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060016573parse-resolv-conf
16574 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
16575 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
16576 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
16577
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016578hold <status> <period>
Christopher Faulet24b319b2023-02-27 17:53:31 +010016579 Upon receiving the DNS response <status>, determines whether a server's state
16580 should change from UP to DOWN. To make that determination, it checks whether
16581 any valid status has been received during the past <period> in order to
16582 counteract the just received invalid status.
16583
16584 <status> : last name resolution status.
16585 nx After receiving an NXDOMAIN status, check for any valid
16586 status during the concluding period.
16587
16588 refused After receiving a REFUSED status, check for any valid
16589 status during the concluding period.
16590
16591 timeout After the "timeout retry" has struck, check for any
16592 valid status during the concluding period.
16593
16594 other After receiving any other invalid status, check for any
16595 valid status during the concluding period.
16596
16597 valid Applies only to "http-request do-resolve" and
16598 "tcp-request content do-resolve" actions. It defines the
16599 period for which the server will maintain a valid response
16600 before triggering another resolution. It does not affect
16601 dynamic resolution of servers.
16602
16603 obsolete Defines how long to wait before removing obsolete DNS
16604 records after an updated answer record is received. It
16605 applies to SRV records.
16606
16607 <period> : Amount of time into the past during which a valid response must
16608 have been received. It follows the HAProxy time format and is in
16609 milliseconds by default.
16610
16611 For a server that relies on dynamic DNS resolution to determine its IP
16612 address, receiving an invalid DNS response, such as NXDOMAIN, will lead to
16613 changing the server's state from UP to DOWN. The hold directives define how
16614 far into the past to look for a valid response. If a valid response has been
16615 received within <period>, the just received invalid status will be ignored.
16616
16617 Unless a valid response has been receiving during the concluding period, the
16618 server will be marked as DOWN. For example, if "hold nx 30s" is set and the
16619 last received DNS response was NXDOMAIN, the server will be marked DOWN
16620 unless a valid response has been received during the last 30 seconds.
16621
16622 A server in the DOWN state will be marked UP immediately upon receiving a
16623 valid status from the DNS server.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016624
Christopher Faulet24b319b2023-02-27 17:53:31 +010016625 A separate behavior exists for "hold valid" and "hold obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016626
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016627resolve_retries <nb>
16628 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
16629 giving up.
16630 Default value: 3
16631
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016632 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
16633 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
16634 type.
16635
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016636timeout <event> <time>
16637 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
16638 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
16639 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016640 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
16641 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016642 Default value: 1s
16643 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016644 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016645 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016646 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
16647 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
16648
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016649 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016650
16651 resolvers mydns
16652 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
16653 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020016654 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060016655 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016656 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016657 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016658 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010016659 hold other 30s
16660 hold refused 30s
16661 hold nx 30s
16662 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016663 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016664 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016665
16666
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200166676. Cache
16668---------
16669
16670HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
16671(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
16672RAM.
16673
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020016674The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
16675blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016676
16677If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
16678independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
16679when we try to allocate a new one.
16680
16681The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
16682
16683It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
16684"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
16685for more details.
16686
16687When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
16688replaced by "<CACHE>".
16689
16690
166916.1. Limitation
16692----------------
16693
16694The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
16695
16696- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010016697- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
16698 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
16699 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016700- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
16701- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010016702- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
16703 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
16704 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016705- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
16706 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010016707- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
16708 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
16709 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016710
16711- If the request is not a GET
16712- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
16713- If the request contains an Authorization header
16714
16715
167166.2. Setup
16717-----------
16718
16719To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
16720the corresponding http-request and response actions.
16721
16722
167236.2.1. Cache section
16724---------------------
16725
16726cache <name>
16727 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
16728 size of cache is mandatory.
16729
16730total-max-size <megabytes>
16731 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
16732 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
16733
16734max-object-size <bytes>
16735 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
16736 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
16737 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
16738
16739max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016740 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016741 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
16742 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
16743 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
16744 default.
16745
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010016746process-vary <on/off>
16747 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010016748 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
16749 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
16750 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010016751 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010016752
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016753max-secondary-entries <number>
16754 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
16755 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
16756 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
16757
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016758
167596.2.2. Proxy section
16760---------------------
16761
16762http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
16763 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
16764 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
16765 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
16766 after this one.
16767
16768http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
16769 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
16770 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
16771 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
16772 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
16773
16774
16775Example:
16776
16777 backend bck1
16778 mode http
16779
16780 http-request cache-use foobar
16781 http-response cache-store foobar
16782 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
16783
16784 cache foobar
16785 total-max-size 4
16786 max-age 240
16787
16788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200167897. Using ACLs and fetching samples
16790----------------------------------
16791
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016792HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016793client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
16794The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
16795these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
16796but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
16797data called patterns.
16798
16799
168007.1. ACL basics
16801---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016802
16803The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
16804content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
16805from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
16806simple :
16807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016808 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016809 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016810 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
16811 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016813The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
16814adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016815
16816In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
16817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016818 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016819
16820This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
16821Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
16822and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016823an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
16824conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
16825as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
16826are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016827
16828ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
16829'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
16830which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
16831
16832There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
16833performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
16834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016835The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
16836specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
16837this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016838methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
16839ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016840
16841Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
16842 - boolean
16843 - integer (signed or unsigned)
16844 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
16845 - string
16846 - data block
16847
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016848Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
16849converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
16850would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
16851The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
16852which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
16853
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016854Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
16855keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
16856fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
16857which are summarized in the table below :
16858
16859 +---------------------+-----------------+
16860 | Sample or converter | Default |
16861 | output type | matching method |
16862 +---------------------+-----------------+
16863 | boolean | bool |
16864 +---------------------+-----------------+
16865 | integer | int |
16866 +---------------------+-----------------+
16867 | ip | ip |
16868 +---------------------+-----------------+
16869 | string | str |
16870 +---------------------+-----------------+
16871 | binary | none, use "-m" |
16872 +---------------------+-----------------+
16873
16874Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
16875matching method, see below.
16876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016877The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
16878 - boolean
16879 - integer or integer range
16880 - IP address / network
16881 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
16882 - regular expression
16883 - hex block
16884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016885The following ACL flags are currently supported :
16886
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016887 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
16888 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016889 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016890 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016891 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016892 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016893 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
16894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016895The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
16896read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
16897if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
16898lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
16899will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
16900beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016901a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016902lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
16903exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
16904
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016905The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
16906parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
16907ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
16908a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
16909check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
16910
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016911The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
16912socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
16913file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
16914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016915Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
16916loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
16917
16918 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
16919
16920In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
16921the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
16922case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
16923as well.
16924
16925The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
16926sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
16927do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
16928methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
16929is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016930obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016931followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
16932default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
16933that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
16934string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
16935
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016936The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
16937By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
16938string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
16939resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016940server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016941waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016942flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
16943function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
16944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016945There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
16946sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
16947be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016948
16949 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
16950 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016951 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
16952 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
16953 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
16954 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016955
16956 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
16957 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016958 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016959
16960 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016961 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016962
16963 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016964 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016965
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016966 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016967 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
16968
16969 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
16970 binary or string samples.
16971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016972 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
16973 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016975 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
16976 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
16977 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016979 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
16980 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016982 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
16983 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016985 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
16986 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016988 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
16989 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016990 This may be used with binary or string samples.
16991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016992 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
16993 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
16994 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016995
16996For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
16997request, it is possible to do :
16998
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016999 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017000
17001In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
17002buffer, one would use the following acl :
17003
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017004 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017005
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017006On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
17007possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
17008
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017009 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017011All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
17012criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
17013method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreau4f4fea42022-11-25 10:49:41 +010017014to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
17015usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
17016converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
17017method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
17018matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017019criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
17020the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017022If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017023the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
17024For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017026 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
17027 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
17028 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
17029 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017030
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017031
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017032The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
17033types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
17034combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
17035brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
17036default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017038 +-------------------------------------------------+
17039 | Input sample type |
17040 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017041 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017042 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
17043 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
17044 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017045 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017046 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017047 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017048 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017049 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017050 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017051 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017052 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017053 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017054 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017055 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017056 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017057 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017058 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017059 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017060 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017061 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017062 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017063 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017064 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017065 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017066 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
17067 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
17068 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017069
17070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200170717.1.1. Matching booleans
17072------------------------
17073
17074In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
17075Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
17076When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
17077that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
17078
17079Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
17080return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
17081"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
17082
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200170847.1.2. Matching integers
17085------------------------
17086
17087Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
17088enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
17089to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
17090
17091Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
17092matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
17093lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017094
17095For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
17096unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
17097representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
17098
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017099As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
17100two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
17101instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
17102ranges and operators.
17103
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017104For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017105operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
17106Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
17107of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017108
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017109Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017110
17111 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
17112 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
17113 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
17114 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
17115 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
17116
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017117For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017118
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017119 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017120
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017121This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
17122
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017123 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017124
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200171267.1.3. Matching strings
17127-----------------------
17128
17129String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
17130different forms :
17131
17132 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017133 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017134
17135 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017136 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017137
17138 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
17139 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17140
17141 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
17142 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17143
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017144 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17145 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
17146 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
17147 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
17148 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
17149 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017150
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017151 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17152 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
17153 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
17154 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
17155 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
17156 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
17157 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
17158 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
17159 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
17160 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
17161 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017162
17163String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
17164exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
17165characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
17166string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
17167to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017168before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017169
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010017170Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
17171(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
17172Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
17173
17174Example:
17175 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
17176 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
17177
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200171797.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
17180---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017181
17182Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
17183they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
17184possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
17185passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
17186the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017187the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
17188match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017189
17190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200171917.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
17192-------------------------------------
17193
17194It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
17195not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
17196a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
17197to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
17198digits may be used upper or lower case.
17199
17200Example :
17201 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017202 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017203
17204
172057.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
17206---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017207
17208IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
17209netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
17210within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010017211host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017212difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
17213at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
17214does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
17215parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017216
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020017217The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
17218abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
17219
17220 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17221 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
17222 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17223 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
17224 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
17225 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
17226 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
17227 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17228
17229Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
17230192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
17231
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020017232IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
17233Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
17234trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
17235IPv6 patterns.
17236
17237HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
17238following situations :
17239 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
17240 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
17241 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
17242 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
17243 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
17244 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
17245 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
17246 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
17247 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
17248 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
17249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017250
172517.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
17252----------------------------------
17253
17254Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
17255combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
17256
17257 - AND (implicit)
17258 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
17259 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017261A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017263 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017265Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
17266indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017268For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
17269"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
17270requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
17271is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
17272
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017273 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017274 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
17275 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
17276 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017277
17278To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
17279and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
17280
17281 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
17282 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
17283 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
17284 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
17285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017286 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017287 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
17288 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
17289 use_backend www if host_www
17290
17291It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
17292expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
17293be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
17294the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
17295
17296 The following rule :
17297
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017298 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017299 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017300
17301 Can also be written that way :
17302
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017303 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017304
17305It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
17306to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
17307simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
17308sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
17309good use is the following :
17310
17311 With named ACLs :
17312
17313 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
17314 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
17315 monitor fail if site_dead
17316
17317 With anonymous ACLs :
17318
17319 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
17320
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017321See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
17322keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017323
17324
173257.3. Fetching samples
17326---------------------
17327
17328Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
17329against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
17330sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
17331ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
17332of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
17333available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
17334
17335This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
17336Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
17337compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
17338deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
17339
17340The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
17341matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
17342method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
17343indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
17344
17345As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
17346when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
17347mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
17348the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
17349ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
17350
17351Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
17352multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
17353when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017354incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
17355are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017356is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
17357all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
17358
17359Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
17360 - name
17361 - name(arg1)
17362 - name(arg1,arg2)
17363
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017364
173657.3.1. Converters
17366-----------------
17367
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017368Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
17369of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
17370is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
17371was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017372has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017373unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
17374
17375These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
17376sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
17377the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017378support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017379
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017380A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
17381support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
17382supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
17383(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
17384bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
17385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017386The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017387
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001738851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
17389 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17390 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17391 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
17392 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17393 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17394
17395 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017396 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
17397 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000017398 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
17399 frontend http-in
17400 bind *:8081
17401 default_backend servers
17402 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17403 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17404
Aurelien DARRAGON5c6f86f2022-12-30 16:23:08 +010017405rfc7239_is_valid
17406 Returns true if input header is RFC 7239 compliant header value and false
17407 otherwise.
17408
17409 Example:
17410 acl valid req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_is_valid
17411 #input: "for=127.0.0.1;proto=http"
17412 # output: TRUE
17413 #input: "proto=custom"
17414 # output: FALSE
17415
Aurelien DARRAGON6fb58b82022-12-30 16:37:03 +010017416rfc7239_field(<field>)
17417 Extracts a single field/parameter from RFC 7239 compliant header value input.
17418
17419 Supported fields are:
17420 - proto: either 'http' or 'https'
17421 - host: http compliant host
17422 - for: RFC7239 node
17423 - by: RFC7239 node
17424
17425 More info here:
17426 https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html#section-6
17427
17428 Example:
17429 # extract host field from forwarded header and store it in req.fhost var
17430 http-request set-var(req.fhost) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(host)
17431 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\""
17432 # output: "haproxy.org:80"
17433
17434 # extract for field from forwarded header and store it in req.ffor var
17435 http-request set-var(req.ffor) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for)
17436 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\";for=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17437 # output: "127.0.0.1:9999"
17438
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010017439rfc7239_n2nn
17440 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17441 into its corresponding nodename final form:
17442 - ipv4 address
17443 - ipv6 address
17444 - 'unknown'
17445 - '_obfs' identifier
17446
17447 Example:
17448 # extract 'for' field from forwarded header, extract nodename from
17449 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnn
17450 http-request set-var(req.fnn) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for),rfc7239_n2nn
17451 #input: "for=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17452 # output: 127.0.0.1
17453 #input: "for=\"_name:_port\""
17454 # output: "_name"
17455
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010017456rfc7239_n2np
17457 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17458 into its corresponding nodeport final form:
17459 - unsigned integer
17460 - '_obfs' identifier
17461
17462 Example:
17463 # extract 'by' field from forwarded header, extract node port from
17464 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnp
17465 http-request set-var(req.fnp) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(by),rfc7239_n2np
17466 #input: "by=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17467 # output: 9999
17468 #input: "by=\"_name:_port\""
17469 # output: "_port"
17470
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017471add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017472 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017473 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017474 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17475 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017476 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017477 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17478 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17479 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17480 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017481 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017482 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017483
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017484add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
17485 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
17486 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
17487 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
17488 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
17489 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17490 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
17491 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
17492 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
17493 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
17494 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
17495 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
17496 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
17497 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
17498 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
17499 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
17500 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
17501 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreaub143d112022-11-25 09:27:15 +010017502 level parser (please see section 2.2 for quoting and escaping). See examples
17503 below.
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017504
17505 Example:
17506 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
17507 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
17508 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
17509 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
17510
17511 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
17512 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
17513
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010017514aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
17515 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
17516 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
17517 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
17518 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
17519 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
17520 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
17521
17522 Example:
17523 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
17524 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
17525
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017526and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017527 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017528 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017529 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17530 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017531 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017532 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17533 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17534 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17535 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017536 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017537 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017538
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017539b64dec
17540 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
17541 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017542 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
17543 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017544
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017545base64
17546 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017547 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017548 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
17549 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017550
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020017551be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
17552 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
17553 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
17554 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
17555 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
17556 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
17557
17558 Example:
17559 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
17560 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
17561 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
17562 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
17563
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020017564be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
17565 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
17566 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
17567 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
17568 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
17569 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
17570 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
17571
17572 Example:
17573 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
17574 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
17575 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
17576 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
17577
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017578bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017579 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017580 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017581 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017582 presence of a flag).
17583
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010017584bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
17585 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
17586 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017587 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010017588
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017589concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
17590 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
17591 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
17592 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
17593 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17594 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
17595 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
17596 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
17597 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
17598 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
17599 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017600 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040017601 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017602 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020017603 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
17604 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
17605 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017606
17607 Example:
17608 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
17609 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
17610 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017611 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020017612 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017613 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
17614
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017615cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017616 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
17617 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017618
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010017619crc32([<avalanche>])
17620 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
17621 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17622 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17623 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17624 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17625 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
17626 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
17627 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
17628 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
17629 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017630 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
17631
17632crc32c([<avalanche>])
17633 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
17634 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17635 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17636 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
17637 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
17638 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
17639 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
17640 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010017641
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020017642cut_crlf
17643 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
17644 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
17645 updated.
17646
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010017647da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017648 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
17649 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
17650 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
17651 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017652 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017653 configuration language.
17654
17655 Example:
17656 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017657 bind *:8881
17658 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000017659 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017660
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010017661debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
17662 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
17663 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
17664 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
17665 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
17666 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
17667 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
17668 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
17669 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
17670 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
17671 printable sample types.
17672
17673 Example:
17674 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020017675
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017676digest(<algorithm>)
17677 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
17678 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
17679
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017680 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017681 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17682
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017683div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017684 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
17685 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017686 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017687 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
17688 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017689 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017690 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17691 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17692 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17693 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017694 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017695 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017696
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017697djb2([<avalanche>])
17698 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
17699 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17700 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17701 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17702 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17703 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17704 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017705 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
17706 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017707
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017708even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017709 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017710 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
17711
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017712field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17713 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
17714 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
17715 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
17716 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
17717 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
17718 fields.
17719
17720 Example :
17721 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
17722 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17723 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
17724 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
17725 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010017726
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017727fix_is_valid
17728 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
17729 Information eXchange):
17730
17731 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
17732 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050017733 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017734 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010017735 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017736 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
17737 checksum
17738
17739 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17740 the server can be parsed.
17741
17742 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
17743 message, false if not.
17744
17745 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
17746
17747 Example:
17748 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17749 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
17750
17751fix_tag_value(<tag>)
17752 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
17753 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
17754 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
17755 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050017756 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017757 added.
17758
17759 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17760 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
17761 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
17762 fix_is_valid converter.
17763
17764 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
17765
17766 Example:
17767 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17768 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
17769 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
17770 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
17771 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
17772
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017773hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017774 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017775 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017776 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017777 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010017778
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020017779hex2i
17780 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017781 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020017782
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020017783htonl
17784 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
17785 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
17786 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
17787 unsigned 32-bit integer.
17788
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010017789hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017790 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
17791 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
17792 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
17793 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
17794
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017795 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017796 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17797
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020017798host_only
17799 Converts a string which contains a Host header value and removes its port.
17800 The input must respect the format of the host header value
17801 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
17802 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
17803
17804 This converter also sets the string in lowercase.
17805
17806 See also: "port_only" converter which will return the port.
17807
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017808http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017809 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17810 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017811 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
17812 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
17813 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
17814 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
17815 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
17816 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
17817 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
17818 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017819
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020017820iif(<true>,<false>)
17821 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
17822 string otherwise.
17823
17824 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020017825 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020017826
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017827in_table(<table>)
17828 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17829 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
17830 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017831 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017832 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
17833
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010017834ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010017835 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017836 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010017837 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
17838 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
17839 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
17840 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
17841 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017842
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017843json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017844 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017845 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020017846 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017847 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
17848 of errors:
17849 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
17850 bytes, ...)
17851 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
17852 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
17853
17854 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
17855 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
17856 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
17857 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
17858 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
17859 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017860 - "ascii" : never fails;
17861 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
17862 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017863 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017864 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017865 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
17866 characters corresponding to the other errors.
17867
17868 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017869 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017870
17871 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017872 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020017873 capture request header user-agent len 150
17874 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017875
17876 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
17877 GET / HTTP/1.0
17878 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
17879
17880 Output log:
17881 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
17882
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020017883json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
17884 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
17885 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
17886 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
17887 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
17888
17889 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
17890 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
17891
17892 Example:
17893 # get a integer value from the request body
17894 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
17895 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
17896
17897 # get a key with '.' in the name
17898 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
17899 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
17900
17901 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
17902 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
17903
17904 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
17905 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
17906
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020017907jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
17908 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
17909 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
17910 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
17911 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
17912 json_path and output_type parameters.
17913
17914 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17915 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17916
17917jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
17918 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
17919 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
17920 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
17921 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
17922 json_path and output_type parameters.
17923
17924 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17925 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17926
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017927jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
17928 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
17929 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017930 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017931 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
17932 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
17933 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
17934 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017935
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017936 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
Remi Tricot-Le Breton447a38f2023-03-07 17:43:57 +010017937 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). All the
17938 algorithms mentioned in section 3.1 of RFC7518 are managed.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017939
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017940 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
17941 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
17942 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
17943 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
17944 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
17945 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017946 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017947 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
17948
17949 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
17950 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
17951 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
17952 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
17953 contents.
17954
17955 The possible return values are the following :
17956
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017957 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
17958 | ID | message |
17959 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017960 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017961 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017962 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton447a38f2023-03-07 17:43:57 +010017963 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017964 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
17965 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
17966 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017967 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017968
17969 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17970 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17971
17972 Example:
17973 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
17974 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
17975 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
17976 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
17977 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) "RS256" }
17978 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
17979
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017980language(<value>[,<default>])
17981 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
17982 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
17983 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
17984 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
17985 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
17986 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
17987 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
17988 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
17989 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017990 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017991 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
17992 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017993
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017994 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017995
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017996 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
17997 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017998
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017999 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
18000 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
18001 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
18002 use_backend spanish if es
18003 use_backend french if fr
18004 use_backend english if en
18005 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018006
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010018007length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010018008 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
18009 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18010 type. The result is of type integer.
18011
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018012lower
18013 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
18014 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18015 type. The result is of type string.
18016
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018017ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
18018 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18019 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
18020 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
18021 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
18022 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
18023 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
18024
18025 Example :
18026
18027 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018028 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018029 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
18030
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020018031ltrim(<chars>)
18032 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
18033 representation of the input sample.
18034
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018035map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18036map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18037map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18038 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
18039 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
18040 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
18041 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
18042 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
18043 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
18044 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
18045 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018046
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018047 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
18048 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
18049 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018050
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018051 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018052 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018053
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018054 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
18055 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18056 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
18057 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020018058 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
18059 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018060 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
18061 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18062 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
18063 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18064 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
18065 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18066 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
18067 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080018068 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
18069 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18070 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018071 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18072 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
18073 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18074 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
18075 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018076
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010018077 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
18078 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
18079 the corresponding match text.
18080
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018081 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
18082 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
18083 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
18084 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
18085 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018086
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018087 Example :
18088
18089 # this is a comment and is ignored
18090 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
18091 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
18092 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
18093 | | | `---------- value
18094 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
18095 | `---------------------------- key
18096 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
18097
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018098mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018099 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
18100 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018101 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018102 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018103 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018104 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18105 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18106 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18107 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018108 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018109 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018110
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018111mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018112 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
18113 <packettype>.
18114 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
18115 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
18116 from.
18117 Supported string and integers can be found here:
18118 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
18119 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
18120
18121 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
18122 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
18123 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
18124 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
18125
18126 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
18127 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
18128 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18129 packets only):
18130 17: Session Expiry Interval
18131 33: Receive Maximum
18132 39: Maximum Packet Size
18133 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18134 25: Request Response Information
18135 23: Request Problem Information
18136 21: Authentication Method
18137 22: Authentication Data
18138 18: Will Delay Interval
18139 1: Payload Format Indicator
18140 2: Message Expiry Interval
18141 3: Content Type
18142 8: Response Topic
18143 9: Correlation Data
18144 Not supported yet:
18145 38: User Property
18146
18147 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
18148 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18149 packets only):
18150 17: Session Expiry Interval
18151 33: Receive Maximum
18152 36: Maximum QoS
18153 37: Retain Available
18154 39: Maximum Packet Size
18155 18: Assigned Client Identifier
18156 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18157 31: Reason String
18158 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
18159 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
18160 42: Shared Subscription Available
18161 19: Server Keep Alive
18162 26: Response Information
18163 28: Server Reference
18164 21: Authentication Method
18165 22: Authentication Data
18166 Not supported yet:
18167 38: User Property
18168
18169 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18170 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18171 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18172 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18173
18174 Example:
18175
18176 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
18177 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18178 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
18179 if data_in_buffer
18180 # do the same as above
18181 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18182 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
18183 if data_in_buffer
18184
18185mqtt_is_valid
18186 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
18187
18188 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18189 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18190 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18191 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18192
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010018193 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
18194
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018195 Example:
18196
18197 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040018198 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018199
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018200mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018201 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020018202 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
18203 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018204 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018205 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018206 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018207 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18208 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18209 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18210 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018211 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018212 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018213
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010018214nbsrv
18215 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
18216 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
18217 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
18218 map lookup.
18219
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018220neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018221 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
18222 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
18223 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
18224 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018225
18226not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018227 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018228 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018229 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018230 absence of a flag).
18231
18232odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018233 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018234 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
18235
18236or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018237 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018238 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018239 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
18240 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018241 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018242 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18243 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18244 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18245 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018246 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018247 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018248
Thayne McCombs02cf4ec2022-12-14 00:19:59 -070018249param(<name>,[<delim>])
18250 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the input string
18251 where parameters are delimited by <delim>, which defaults to "&", and the name
18252 and value of the parameter are separated by a "=". If there is no "=" and
18253 value before the end of the parameter segment, it is treated as equivalent to
18254 a value of an empty string.
18255
18256 This can be useful for extracting parameters from a query string, or possibly
18257 a x-www-form-urlencoded body. In particular, `query,param(<name>)` can be used
18258 as an alternative to `urlp(<name>)` which only uses "&" as a delimiter,
18259 whereas "urlp" also uses "?" and ";".
18260
18261 Note that this converter doesn't do anything special with url encoded
18262 characters. If you want to decode the value, you can use the url_dec converter
18263 on the output. If the name of the parameter in the input might contain encoded
18264 characters, you'll probably want do normalize the input before calling
18265 "param". This can be done using "http-request normalize-uri", in particular
18266 the percent-decode-unreserved and percent-to-uppercase options.
18267
18268 Example :
18269 str(a=b&c=d&a=r),param(a) # b
18270 str(a&b=c),param(a) # ""
18271 str(a=&b&c=a),param(b) # ""
18272 str(a=1;b=2;c=4),param(b,;) # 2
18273 query,param(redirect_uri),urldec()
18274
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018275port_only
18276 Converts a string which contains a Host header value into an integer by
18277 returning its port.
18278 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18279 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18280 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18281
18282 If no port were provided in the input, it will return 0.
18283
18284 See also: "host_only" converter which will return the host.
18285
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018286protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
18287 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
18288 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
18289 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
18290 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
18291 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18292 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18293 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18294 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
18295 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
18296 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18297 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
18298
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010018299regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018300 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
18301 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
18302 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
18303 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
18304 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
18305 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
18306 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
18307 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
18308 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018309 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
18310 of characters with other ones.
18311
18312 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
18313 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
18314 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
18315 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
18316 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
18317 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018318
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018319 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018320
18321 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
18322 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
18323 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018324 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018325
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018326 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
18327 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
18328
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018329 # capture groups and backreferences
18330 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020018331 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018332 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
18333
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018334capture-req(<id>)
18335 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
18336 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18337
18338 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018339 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18340 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018341
18342capture-res(<id>)
18343 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
18344 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18345
18346 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018347 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18348 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018349
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020018350rtrim(<chars>)
18351 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
18352 of the input sample.
18353
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018354sdbm([<avalanche>])
18355 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
18356 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18357 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18358 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18359 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18360 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18361 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018362 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
18363 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018364
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018365secure_memcmp(<var>)
18366 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
18367 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
18368 match.
18369
18370 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
18371 performed in constant time.
18372
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018373 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018374 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18375
18376 Example :
18377
18378 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
18379 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
18380 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
18381 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
18382
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018383set-var(<var>[,<cond> ...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018384 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018385 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
18386 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
18387 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
18388 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018389 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018390 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18391 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018392 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018393 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18394 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018395 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018396 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018397
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018398 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
18399 possible conditions :
18400 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
18401 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
18402 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
18403 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
18404 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
18405 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
18406 Checks if the input is empty or not.
18407 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
18408 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
18409 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
18410 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
18411 called on the variable.
18412 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
18413 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
18414 configuration parsing.
18415 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
18416 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
18417 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
18418 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
18419 true by default.
18420
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018421sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018422 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018423 sample with length of 20 bytes.
18424
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018425sha2([<bits>])
18426 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
18427 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
18428
18429 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
18430 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
18431
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018432 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018433 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18434
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020018435srv_queue
18436 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
18437 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
18438 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
18439 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
18440 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
18441
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018442strcmp(<var>)
18443 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
18444 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
18445 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
18446 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
18447 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
18448 shorter).
18449
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018450 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
18451 strings in constant time.
18452
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018453 Example :
18454
18455 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
18456 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
18457 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
18458
18459
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018460sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018461 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
18462 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018463 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018464 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
18465 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018466 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018467 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18468 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018469 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018470 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18471 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018472 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018473 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018474
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018475table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
18476 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18477 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18478 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
18479 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18480 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18481 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
18482
18483
18484table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
18485 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18486 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18487 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
18488 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18489 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18490 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
18491
18492table_conn_cnt(<table>)
18493 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18494 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018495 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018496 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
18497 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18498
18499table_conn_cur(<table>)
18500 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18501 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18502 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
18503 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18504 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
18505
18506table_conn_rate(<table>)
18507 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18508 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18509 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
18510 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18511 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
18512
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020018513table_expire(<table>[,<default_value>])
18514 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
18515 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
18516 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
18517 is found the converter returns the key expiration delay associated with the
18518 input sample in the designated table.
18519 See also the table_idle sample fetch keyword.
18520
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018521table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
18522 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18523 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18524 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
18525 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
18526 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18527 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18528 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
18529 data-type).
18530 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18531
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018532table_gpt0(<table>)
18533 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18534 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18535 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18536 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18537 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
18538
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018539table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
18540 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18541 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18542 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
18543 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
18544 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
18545 between 0 and 99.
18546 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18547 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18548 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18549 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
18550
18551table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
18552 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18553 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18554 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
18555 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
18556 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
18557 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18558 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
18559 value 0.
18560 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
18561 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18562 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
18563
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018564table_gpc0(<table>)
18565 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18566 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18567 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18568 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
18569 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
18570
18571table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
18572 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18573 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18574 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
18575 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
18576 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
18577 sample fetch keyword.
18578
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018579table_gpc1(<table>)
18580 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18581 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18582 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
18583 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
18584 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
18585
18586table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
18587 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18588 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18589 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
18590 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
18591 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
18592 sample fetch keyword.
18593
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018594table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
18595 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18596 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018597 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018598 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18599 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18600
18601table_http_err_rate(<table>)
18602 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18603 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18604 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
18605 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
18606 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
18607 keyword.
18608
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018609table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
18610 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18611 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18612 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
18613 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
18614 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18615
18616table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
18617 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18618 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18619 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
18620 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
18621 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
18622 keyword.
18623
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018624table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
18625 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18626 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018627 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018628 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
18629 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18630
18631table_http_req_rate(<table>)
18632 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18633 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18634 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
18635 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
18636 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
18637 keyword.
18638
Aurelien DARRAGONfd766dd2022-11-23 14:35:06 +010018639table_idle(<table>[,<default_value>])
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020018640 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
18641 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
18642 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
18643 is found the converter returns the time the key entry associated with the
18644 input sample in the designated table remained idle since the last time it was
18645 updated.
18646 See also the table_expire sample fetch keyword.
18647
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018648table_kbytes_in(<table>)
18649 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18650 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018651 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018652 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
18653 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
18654 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
18655 keyword.
18656
18657table_kbytes_out(<table>)
18658 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18659 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018660 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018661 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
18662 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
18663 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
18664 keyword.
18665
18666table_server_id(<table>)
18667 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18668 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18669 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
18670 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
18671 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
18672 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
18673
18674table_sess_cnt(<table>)
18675 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18676 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018677 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018678 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
18679 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
18680 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
18681 keyword.
18682
18683table_sess_rate(<table>)
18684 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18685 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18686 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
18687 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
18688 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
18689 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
18690 keyword.
18691
18692table_trackers(<table>)
18693 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18694 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18695 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
18696 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
18697 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
18698 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
18699 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
18700 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
18701 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
18702 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
18703
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020018704ub64dec
18705 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
18706 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
18707 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
18708
18709 Example:
18710 # Decoding a JWT payload:
18711 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
18712
18713ub64enc
18714 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
18715
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018716upper
18717 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
18718 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18719 type. The result is of type string.
18720
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020018721url_dec([<in_form>])
18722 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
18723 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
18724 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
18725 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
18726 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
18727 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020018728
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010018729url_enc([<enc_type>])
18730 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
18731 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
18732 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
18733 optional argument is here for future changes.
18734
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018735ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018736 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018737 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
18738 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
18739 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018740 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18741 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18742 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18743 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010018744 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018745 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18746 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018747
18748 Example:
18749 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
18750 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
18751
18752 message Point {
18753 int32 latitude = 1;
18754 int32 longitude = 2;
18755 }
18756
18757 message PPoint {
18758 Point point = 59;
18759 }
18760
18761 message Rectangle {
18762 // One corner of the rectangle.
18763 PPoint lo = 48;
18764 // The other corner of the rectangle.
18765 PPoint hi = 49;
18766 }
18767
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018768 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
18769 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
18770 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018771
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018772 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
18773 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018774 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018775 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
18776
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018777 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018778
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010018779 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018780
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018781 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
18782 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
18783 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018784
18785 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
18786 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
18787 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
18788
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018789 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
18790 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
18791 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018792
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018793
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010018794unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010018795 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
18796 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
18797 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
18798 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18799 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
18800 response),
18801 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18802 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
18803 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
18804 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
18805
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018806utime(<format>[,<offset>])
18807 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18808 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
18809 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
18810 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
18811 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
18812 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
18813
18814 Example :
18815
18816 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018817 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018818 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
18819
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018820word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
18821 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
18822 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
18823 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010018824 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018825 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
18826 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
18827
18828 Example :
18829 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
18830 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
18831 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
18832 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
18833 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010018834 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010018835
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018836wt6([<avalanche>])
18837 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
18838 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18839 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18840 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18841 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18842 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18843 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018844 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
18845 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018846
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018847xor(<value>)
18848 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018849 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018850 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018851 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018852 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018853 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18854 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018855 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018856 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18857 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018858 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018859 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018860
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010018861xxh3([<seed>])
18862 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
18863 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
18864 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
18865 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
18866 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
18867 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
18868 considered as cryptographically secure.
18869
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010018870xxh32([<seed>])
18871 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
18872 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
18873 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
18874 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
18875 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
18876 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
18877 as cryptographically secure.
18878
18879xxh64([<seed>])
18880 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
18881 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
18882 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
18883 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
18884 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
18885 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
18886 as cryptographically secure.
18887
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010018888x509_v_err_str
18889 Convert a numerical value to its corresponding X509_V_ERR constant name. It
18890 is useful in ACL in order to have a configuration which works with multiple
18891 version of OpenSSL since some codes might change when changing version.
18892
18893 The list of constant provided by OpenSSL can be found at
18894 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
18895 Be careful to read the page for the right version of OpenSSL.
18896
18897 Example:
18898
18899 bind :443 ssl crt common.pem ca-file ca-auth.crt verify optional crt-ignore-err X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED,X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
18900
18901 acl cert_expired ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
18902 acl cert_revoked ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED
18903 acl cert_ok ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_OK
18904
18905 http-response add-header X-SSL Ok if cert_ok
18906 http-response add-header X-SSL Expired if cert_expired
18907 http-response add-header X-SSL Revoked if cert_revoked
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018908
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200189097.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018910--------------------------------------------
18911
18912A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
18913not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
18914"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
18915The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
18916
18917always_false : boolean
18918 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
18919 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
18920
18921always_true : boolean
18922 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
18923 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
18924
18925avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018926 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018927 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
18928 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
18929 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
18930 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
18931 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
18932 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
18933 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
18934 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
18935 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
18936 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
18937 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
18938 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
18939 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010018940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018941be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018942 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
18943 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
18944 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
18945 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040018946 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
18947
18948be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
18949 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
18950 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
18951 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
18952 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
18953 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040018954 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
18955 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040018956
18957 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
18958 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
18959 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018961be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
18962 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18963 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
18964 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018965 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018966 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
18967 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018968
18969 Example :
18970 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
18971 backend dynamic
18972 mode http
18973 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
18974 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018975
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018976bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018977 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
18978 of the string.
18979
18980bool(<bool>) : bool
18981 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
18982 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
18983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018984connslots([<backend>]) : integer
18985 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018986 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018987 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
18988 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050018989
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018990 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018991 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018992 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
18993
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018994 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
18995 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018996
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018997 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018998 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018999 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019000 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019001 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019002 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019003 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019004
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019005 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
19006 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019007 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019008 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019009
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019010cpu_calls : integer
19011 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
19012 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
19013 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
19014 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
19015 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
19016 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
19017
19018cpu_ns_avg : integer
19019 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
19020 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
19021 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
19022 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
19023 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
19024 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
19025 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
19026 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
19027 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
19028 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
19029 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
19030
19031cpu_ns_tot : integer
19032 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
19033 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
19034 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
19035 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
19036 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
19037 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
19038 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
19039 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
19040 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
19041 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
19042 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
19043 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
19044 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
19045
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010019046date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020019047 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019048
19049 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
19050 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
19051 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020019052 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
19053
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019054 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
19055 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
19056 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
19057 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
19058 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
19059
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020019060 Example :
19061
19062 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
19063 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020019064
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019065 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
19066 # millisecond granularity
19067 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
19068
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010019069date_us : integer
19070 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
19071 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
19072 from the same timeval structure.
19073
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020019074env(<name>) : string
19075 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
19076 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
19077 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
19078 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
19079 certain way.
19080
19081 Examples :
19082 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
19083 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
19084
19085 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019086 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020019087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019088fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
19089 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019090 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
19091 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019092 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
19093 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019094 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019095 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
19096 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019097
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020019098fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
19099 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
19100 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
19101 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
19102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019103fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
19104 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19105 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
19106 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
19107 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
19108 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
19109 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
19110 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
19111 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019112
19113 Example :
19114 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
19115 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
19116 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
19117 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
19118 frontend mail
19119 bind :25
19120 mode tcp
19121 maxconn 100
19122 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
19123 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
19124 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
19125 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019126
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010019127hostname : string
19128 Returns the system hostname.
19129
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020019130int(<integer>) : signed integer
19131 Returns a signed integer.
19132
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019133ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
19134 Returns an ipv4.
19135
19136ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
19137 Returns an ipv6.
19138
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019139last_rule_file : string
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019140 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
19141 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
19142 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19143 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19144 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19145 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19146 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19147 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19148 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19149 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19150 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19151 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
19152
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019153last_rule_line : integer
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019154 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
19155 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
19156 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19157 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19158 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19159 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19160 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19161 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19162 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19163 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19164 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19165 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
19166
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019167lat_ns_avg : integer
19168 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19169 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19170 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19171 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19172 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19173 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19174 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19175 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19176 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019177 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19178 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19179 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19180 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19181 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
19182 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019183
19184lat_ns_tot : integer
19185 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19186 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19187 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19188 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19189 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19190 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19191 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19192 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19193 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019194 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19195 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19196 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19197 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19198 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019199 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
19200 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
19201 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
19202 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
19203 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
19204 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
19205
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019206meth(<method>) : method
19207 Returns a method.
19208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019209nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
19210 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
19211 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
19212 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019213 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
19214 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
19215 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019216
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040019217prio_class : integer
19218 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
19219 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
19220 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
19221
19222prio_offset : integer
19223 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
19224 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
19225 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
19226 set-priority-offset".
19227
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019228proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020019229 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
19230 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019232queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019233 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
19234 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
19235 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019236 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
19237 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
19238 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
19239 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
19240 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
19241
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019242quic_enabled : boolean
19243 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
19244 change without deprecation in the future.
19245
19246 Return true when the support for QUIC transport protocol was compiled and
19247 if this procotol was not disabled by "no-quic" global option. See also "no-quic"
19248 global option.
19249
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010019250rand([<range>]) : integer
19251 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
19252 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
19253 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
19254 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
19255 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
19256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019257srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19258 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19259 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
19260 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
19261 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
19262 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019263 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
19264 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
19265
19266srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19267 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19268 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
19269 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19270 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
19271 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
19272 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
19273 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
19274
19275 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
19276 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019277
19278srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
19279 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
19280 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
19281 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019282 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019283 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
19284 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
19285 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
19286
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020019287srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19288 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
19289 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19290 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
19291 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
19292 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
19293 fetch methods.
19294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019295srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19296 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19297 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019298 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019299 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
19300 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019301 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019302 overloading servers).
19303
19304 Example :
19305 # Redirect to a separate back
19306 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
19307 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
19308 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
19309
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019310srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019311 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
19312 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
19313 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
19314
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019315srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019316 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
19317 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19318 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
19319
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019320srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019321 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
19322 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19323 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
19324
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019325stopping : boolean
19326 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
19327 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
19328 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
19329
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019330str(<string>) : string
19331 Returns a string.
19332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019333table_avl([<table>]) : integer
19334 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
19335 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
19336
19337table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19338 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
19339 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
19340 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
19341
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010019342thread : integer
19343 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
19344 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
19345 and debugging purposes.
19346
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020019347uuid([<version>]) : string
19348 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
19349 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
19350 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
19351
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019352var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019353 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019354 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
19355 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
19356 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019357 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019358 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19359 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019360 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019361 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19362 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019363 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019364 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019365
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200193667.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019367----------------------------------
19368
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019369The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019370closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
19371methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
19372sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
19373TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019374the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
19375counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020019376"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +010019377used if the global "tune.stick-counters" value does not exceed 3, otherwise the
19378counter number can be specified as the first integer argument when using the
19379"sc_" prefix starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (tune.stick-counters-1).
19380An optional table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the
19381currently tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of
19382the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019383
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019384bc_dst : ip
19385 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
19386 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
19387 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
19388 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19389
19390bc_dst_port : integer
19391 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019392 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019393
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019394bc_err : integer
19395 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
19396 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
19397 and their corresponding error message.
19398
19399bc_err_str : string
19400 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
19401 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
19402 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
19403 corresponding error message.
19404
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010019405bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010019406 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19407 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19408 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
19409
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019410bc_src : ip
19411 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019412 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019413 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19414 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19415
19416bc_src_port : integer
19417 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019418 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019420be_id : integer
19421 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019422 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19423 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019424
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019425be_name : string
19426 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019427 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19428 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019429
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010019430be_server_timeout : integer
19431 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
19432 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19433 also the "cur_server_timeout".
19434
19435be_tunnel_timeout : integer
19436 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
19437 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19438 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
19439
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010019440cur_server_timeout : integer
19441 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19442 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
19443 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
19444
19445cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
19446 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19447 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
19448 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
19449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019450dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019451 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
19452 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
19453 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
19454 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
19455 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
19456 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
19457 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
19458 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
19459 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
19460 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
19461 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019462
19463dst_conn : integer
19464 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19465 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
19466 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
19467 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
19468 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
19469 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
19470 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
19471 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019472
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019473dst_is_local : boolean
19474 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
19475 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
19476 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
19477 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019478 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019479 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
19480 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
19481 it only once per connection.
19482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019483dst_port : integer
19484 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
19485 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019486 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
19487 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
19488 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
19489 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019490
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019491fc_dst : ip
19492 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
19493 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
19494 for details.
19495
19496fc_dst_is_local : boolean
19497 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
19498 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
19499 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
19500
19501fc_dst_port : integer
19502 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
19503 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
19504 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
19505
19506fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019507 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
19508 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
19509 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019510 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019511 error codes and their corresponding error message.
19512
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019513fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050019514 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019515 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019516 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019517 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
19518
19519 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19520 | ID | message |
19521 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19522 | 0 | "Success" |
19523 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
19524 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
19525 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
19526 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
19527 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
19528 | 6 | "General socket error" |
19529 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
19530 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
19531 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
19532 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
19533 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19534 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19535 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19536 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
19537 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
19538 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
19539 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
19540 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19541 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19542 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
19543 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
19544 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
19545 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
19546 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
19547 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
19548 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
19549 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
19550 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
19551 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
19552 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
19553 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
19554 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
19555 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
19556 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
19557 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
19558 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
19559 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
19560 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
19561 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
19562 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
19563 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
19564 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020019565 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019566 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19567
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019568fc_fackets : integer
19569 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
19570 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19571 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19572 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19573
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020019574fc_http_major : integer
19575 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19576 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19577 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
19578
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019579fc_lost : integer
19580 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
19581 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19582 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19583 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19584
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020019585fc_pp_authority : string
19586 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
19587 if any.
19588
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010019589fc_pp_unique_id : string
19590 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
19591 if any.
19592
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010019593fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
19594 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
19595 header.
19596
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019597fc_reordering : integer
19598 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
19599 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19600 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19601 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19602
19603fc_retrans : integer
19604 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
19605 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19606 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19607 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19608
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020019609fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
19610 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
19611 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
19612 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
19613 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19614 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19615 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19616
19617fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
19618 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
19619 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
19620 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
19621 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19622 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19623 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19624
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020019625fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019626 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
19627 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
19628 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
19629 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19630
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019631fc_src : ip
19632 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
19633 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src"
19634 for details.
19635
19636fc_src_is_local : boolean
19637 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
19638 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
19639 "src_is_local" for details.
19640
19641fc_src_port : integer
19642
19643 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
19644 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
19645 this address. See "src-port" for details.
19646
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019647
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019648fc_unacked : integer
19649 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
19650 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
19651 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
19652 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019653
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020019654fe_defbe : string
19655 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
19656 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
19657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019658fe_id : integer
19659 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010019660 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019661 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
19662
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019663fe_name : string
19664 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
19665 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
19666 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
19667
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010019668fe_client_timeout : integer
19669 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
19670 current frontend.
19671
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019672sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019673sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19674sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19675sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019676 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
19677 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
19678 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
19679
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019680sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019681sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19682sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19683sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019684 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
19685 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
19686 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
19687
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019688sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19689 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19690 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
19691 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
19692 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19693 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19694 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
19695 will always return zero.
19696 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19697 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19698
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019699sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019700sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19701sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19702sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019703 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
19704 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019705 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
19706 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
19707 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019708
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019709 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019710 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
19711 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019712 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
19713 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
19714 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019715 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
19716 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19717
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019718sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19719sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19720sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19721sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19722 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
19723 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
19724 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
19725 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
19726 when a first ACL was verified.
19727
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019728sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019729sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19730sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19731sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019732 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019733 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
19734
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019735sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019736sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
19737sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
19738sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019739 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
19740 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
19741 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
19742
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019743sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019744sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19745sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19746sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019747 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
19748 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
19749 See also src_conn_rate.
19750
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019751sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19752 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
19753 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
19754 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
19755 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19756 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
19757 index, zero is returned.
19758 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19759 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
19760
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019761sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019762sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19763sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19764sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019765 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019766 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019767
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019768sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19769sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19770sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19771sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19772 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
19773 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
19774
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019775sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19776 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
19777 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
19778 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
19779 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19780 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
19781 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
19782 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
19783
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019784sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19785sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19786sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19787sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19788 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
19789 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
19790
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019791sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19792 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
19793 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
19794 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
19795 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
19796 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
19797 between 0 and 2.
19798 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
19799 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
19800 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
19801 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19802 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
19803
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019804sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019805sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
19806sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
19807sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019808 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
19809 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
19810 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019811 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
19812 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19813 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019814
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019815sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19816sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19817sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19818sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19819 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
19820 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
19821 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
19822 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
19823 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19824 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
19825
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019826sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019827sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19828sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19829sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019830 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019831 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
19832 See also src_http_err_cnt.
19833
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019834sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019835sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19836sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19837sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019838 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
19839 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
19840 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
19841 src_http_err_rate.
19842
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019843sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19844sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19845sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19846sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19847 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
19848 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
19849 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
19850
19851sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19852sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19853sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19854sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19855 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
19856 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
19857 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
19858 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
19859
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019860sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019861sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19862sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19863sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019864 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019865 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
19866 src_http_req_cnt.
19867
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019868sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019869sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19870sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19871sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019872 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
19873 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
19874 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
19875 src_http_req_rate.
19876
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019877sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19878 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19879 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
19880 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
19881 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19882 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19883 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
19884 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
19885 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19886 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19887
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019888sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019889sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19890sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19891sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019892 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019893 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
19894 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
19895 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
19896 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019897
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019898 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019899 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
19900 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019901 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19902
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019903sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19904sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19905sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19906sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19907 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
19908 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
19909 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
19910 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
19911 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
19912
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019913sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019914sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
19915sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
19916sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019917 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
19918 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
19919 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019920
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019921sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019922sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
19923sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
19924sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019925 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
19926 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
19927 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019928
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019929sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019930sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19931sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19932sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019933 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019934 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
19935 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
19936 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019937 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019938 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
19939
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019940sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019941sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19942sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19943sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019944 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
19945 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
19946 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
19947 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
19948 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019949 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019950
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019951sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019952sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
19953sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
19954sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020019955 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
19956 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
19957 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
19958
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019959sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019960sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
19961sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
19962sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019963 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
19964 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019965 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019966 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
19967 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019968 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
19969 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
19970 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019972so_id : integer
19973 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
19974 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
19975 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019976
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010019977so_name : string
19978 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
19979 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
19980 strings instead of integers.
19981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019982src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019983 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
19984 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
19985 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19986 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
19987 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
19988 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
19989 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
19990 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
19991 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
19992 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
19993 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
19994 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
19995 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
19996 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
19997 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019998
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010019999 Example:
20000 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
20001 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
20002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020003src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20004 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
20005 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
20006 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020007 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020009src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20010 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
20011 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020012 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020013 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020014
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020015src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20016 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20017 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20018 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
20019 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20020 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
20021 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20022 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20023 See also sc_clr_gpc.
20024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020025src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20026 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20027 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20028 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
20029 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
20030 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
20031 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020032
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020033 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020034 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
20035 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
20036 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
20037 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020038 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020039 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
20040 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20041
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020042src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20043 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20044 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20045 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
20046 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
20047 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
20048 was verified.
20049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020050src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020051 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020052 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020053 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020054 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020056src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020057 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020058 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20059 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020060 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020062src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20063 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
20064 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20065 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020066 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020067
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020068src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20069 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
20070 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
20071 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
20072 is an integer between 0 and 99.
20073 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
20074 is returned.
20075 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
20076 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20077 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
20078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020079src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020080 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020081 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020082 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020083 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020084
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020085src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20086 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
20087 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
20088 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20089 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
20090
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020020091src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
20092 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
20093 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
20094 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
20095 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20096 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
20097 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
20098
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020020099src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20100 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
20101 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
20102 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20103 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
20104
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020105src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
20106 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
20107 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
20108 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20109 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
20110 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20111 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
20112 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
20113 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
20114 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
20115 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
20116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020117src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020118 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020119 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020120 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
20121 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020122 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
20123 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20124 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020125
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020126src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20127 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
20128 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20129 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
20130 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
20131 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
20132 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20133 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
20134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020135src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020136 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020137 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020138 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020139 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020140 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020142src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20143 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
20144 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20145 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
20146 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020147 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020148
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020149src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20150 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
20151 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050020152 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020153 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
20154 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20155
20156src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20157 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
20158 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20159 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
20160 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
20161 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
20162 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
20163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020164src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020165 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020166 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20167 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020168 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020170src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20171 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
20172 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20173 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020174 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020175 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020176
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020177src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20178 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
20179 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20180 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
20181 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20182 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
20183 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20184 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20185 See also sc_inc_gpc.
20186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020187src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20188 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20189 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20190 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020191 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020192 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20193 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020194
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020195 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020196 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020197 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020198 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020199
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020200src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20201 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20202 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20203 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
20204 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20205 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20206 connection when a first ACL was verified.
20207
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020208src_is_local : boolean
20209 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
20210 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
20211 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
20212 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020213 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020214 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
20215 once per connection.
20216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020217src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020218 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
20219 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20220 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
20221 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
20222 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020224src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020225 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
20226 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20227 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
20228 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
20229 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020231src_port : integer
20232 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020233 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
20234 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
20235 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
20236 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010020237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020238src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020239 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020240 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20241 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
20242 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020243 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020245src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20246 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
20247 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20248 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20249 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020250 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020252src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20253 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
20254 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
20255 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
20256 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
20257 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
20258 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
20259 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
20260 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020261
20262 Example :
20263 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
20264 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
20265 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
20266 listen ssh
20267 bind :22
20268 mode tcp
20269 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020270 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020271 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020272 server local 127.0.0.1:22
20273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020274srv_id : integer
20275 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
20276 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020277 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020020278
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020279srv_name : string
20280 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
20281 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020282 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020283
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200202847.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020285----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020020286
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020287The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020288closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
20289when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
20290usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020291future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020292
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00002029351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
20294 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
20295 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
20296 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
20297 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
20298 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
20299
20300 Example :
20301 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
20302 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
20303 # the request.
20304 frontend http-in
20305 bind *:8081
20306 default_backend servers
20307 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
20308 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
20309
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020310ssl_bc : boolean
20311 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20312 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020313 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20314 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020315
20316ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
20317 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020318 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20319 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020320
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020321ssl_bc_alpn : string
20322 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
20323 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020324 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020325 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20326 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20327 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
20328 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
20329 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020330 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
20331 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020332
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020333ssl_bc_cipher : string
20334 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020335 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20336 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020337
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020338ssl_bc_client_random : binary
20339 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20340 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20341 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020342 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020343
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020344ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020345 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020346 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
20347 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
20348 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
20349 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020350 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
20351 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
20352 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
20353
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020354ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020355 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020356 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
20357 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
20358 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020359
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020360ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
20361 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20362 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020363 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20364 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020365
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020366ssl_bc_npn : string
20367 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
20368 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020369 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020370 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
20371 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
20372 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
20373 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020374 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
20375 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020376
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020377ssl_bc_protocol : string
20378 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020379 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20380 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020381
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020382ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020383 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020384 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020385 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
20386 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020387
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020388ssl_bc_server_random : binary
20389 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20390 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20391 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020392 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020393
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020394ssl_bc_session_id : binary
20395 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
20396 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020397 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20398 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020399
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020400ssl_bc_session_key : binary
20401 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
20402 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20403 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020404 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020405
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020406ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
20407 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020408 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20409 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020411ssl_c_ca_err : integer
20412 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20413 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
20414 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
20415 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
20416 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020418ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
20419 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20420 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
20421 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
20422 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020423
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020424ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020425 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
20426 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20427 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050020428 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020429 does not support resumed sessions.
20430
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020431ssl_c_der : binary
20432 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
20433 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20434 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020436ssl_c_err : integer
20437 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20438 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
20439 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
20440 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
20441 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020442
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020443ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020444 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20445 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20446 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20447 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20448 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20449 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20450 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20451 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020452 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20453 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20454 LDAP v3.
20455 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20456 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020458ssl_c_key_alg : string
20459 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20460 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20461 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020463ssl_c_notafter : string
20464 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
20465 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20466 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020020467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020468ssl_c_notbefore : string
20469 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
20470 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20471 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010020472
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020473ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020474 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20475 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20476 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20477 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20478 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20479 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20480 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20481 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020482 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20483 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20484 LDAP v3.
20485 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20486 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010020487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020488ssl_c_serial : binary
20489 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
20490 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20491 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020493ssl_c_sha1 : binary
20494 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
20495 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
20496 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020497 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
20498 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
20499
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020500 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020501 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020503ssl_c_sig_alg : string
20504 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20505 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20506 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020508ssl_c_used : boolean
20509 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
20510 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020512ssl_c_verify : integer
20513 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
20514 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
20515 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
20516 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020518ssl_c_version : integer
20519 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
20520 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020521
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010020522ssl_f_der : binary
20523 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
20524 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20525 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20526
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020527ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020528 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20529 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20530 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20531 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020532 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020533 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20534 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20535 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020536 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20537 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20538 LDAP v3.
20539 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20540 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020542ssl_f_key_alg : string
20543 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20544 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
20545 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020547ssl_f_notafter : string
20548 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
20549 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20550 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020552ssl_f_notbefore : string
20553 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
20554 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20555 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020556
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020557ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020558 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20559 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20560 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20561 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20562 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20563 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20564 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20565 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020566 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20567 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20568 LDAP v3.
20569 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20570 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020572ssl_f_serial : binary
20573 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
20574 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20575 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020576
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020020577ssl_f_sha1 : binary
20578 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
20579 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
20580 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
20581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020582ssl_f_sig_alg : string
20583 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20584 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20585 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020587ssl_f_version : integer
20588 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
20589 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
20590
20591ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020592 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20593 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
20594 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
20595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020596 Example :
20597 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
20598 listen http-https
20599 bind :80
20600 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
20601 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
20602
20603ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
20604 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
20605 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
20606
20607ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020608 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020609 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020610 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020611 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20612 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20613 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
20614 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
20615 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
20616 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
20617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020618ssl_fc_cipher : string
20619 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
20620 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020020621
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020622ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20623 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
20624 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020625 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020626 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20627 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20628 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020629
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020630 Example:
20631 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20632 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20633 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20634 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20635 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20636 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20637 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20638 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20639 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20640
20641ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020642 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020643 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020644 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
20645 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020646 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20647 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020648
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020649ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020650 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020651 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020652 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020653 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20654 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20655 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20656 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
20657 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
20658 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020659
20660ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020661 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020662 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
20663 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020664
20665ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
20666 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
20667 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020668 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020669
20670 Example:
20671 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20672 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20673 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20674 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20675 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20676 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20677 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20678 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20679 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20680
20681ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20682 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
20683 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020684 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020685 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20686 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
20687 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20688
20689 Example:
20690 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20691 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20692 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20693 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20694 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20695 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20696 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20697 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20698 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20699
20700ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20701 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
20702 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020703 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020704 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20705 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
20706 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20707
20708 Example:
20709 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20710 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20711 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20712 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20713 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20714 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20715 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20716 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20717 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020718
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020719ssl_fc_client_random : binary
20720 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
20721 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20722 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
20723
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020020724ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
20725 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20726 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20727 transport layer.
20728 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20729 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20730 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20731 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20732
20733ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
20734 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20735 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20736 transport layer.
20737 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20738 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20739 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20740 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20741
20742ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
20743 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
20744 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20745 transport layer.
20746 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20747 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20748 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20749 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20750
20751ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
20752 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20753 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20754 transport layer.
20755 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20756 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20757 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20758 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20759
20760ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
20761 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20762 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
20763 transport layer.
20764 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20765 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20766 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20767 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20768
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020769ssl_fc_err : integer
20770 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20771 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
20772 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
20773 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
20774 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
20775 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
20776 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
20777 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
20778 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
20779 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
20780 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
20781 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
20782 codes.
20783
20784ssl_fc_err_str : string
20785 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20786 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
20787 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
20788 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
20789 also "ssl_fc_err".
20790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020791ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020792 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
20793 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010020794 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
20795 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
20796 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
20797 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020798
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020020799ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
20800 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
20801 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
20802 wait until the handshake happened.
20803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020804ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
20805 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020020806 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
20807 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020808 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020020809 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020810
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020020811ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020020812 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010020813 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
20814 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020020815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020816ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020817 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020818 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020819 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
20820 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
20821 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
20822 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
20823 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
20824 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020020825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020826ssl_fc_protocol : string
20827 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
20828 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020829
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020830ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
20831 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
20832 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020833 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
20834 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020835
20836 Example:
20837 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20838 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20839 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20840 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20841 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20842 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20843 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20844 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20845 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20846
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020847ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040020848 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020849 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010020850 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040020851
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020020852ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
20853 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20854 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20855 transport layer.
20856 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20857 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20858 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20859 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20860
20861ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
20862 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
20863 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
20864 transport layer.
20865 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20866 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20867 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20868 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20869
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020870ssl_fc_server_random : binary
20871 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
20872 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20873 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
20874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020875ssl_fc_session_id : binary
20876 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
20877 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
20878 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
20879 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020880
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020881ssl_fc_session_key : binary
20882 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
20883 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20884 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
20885 BoringSSL.
20886
20887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020888ssl_fc_sni : string
20889 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
20890 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020891 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020892 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
20893 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
20894
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020895 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020896 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020897 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020898 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020020899 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020900
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010020901 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
20902 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
20903 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
20904 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
20905 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
20906 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
20907 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
20908 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
20909 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
20910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020911 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020912 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
20913 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020020914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020915ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
20916 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
20917 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020918
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020919ssl_s_der : binary
20920 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
20921 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20922 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20923
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020924ssl_s_chain_der : binary
20925 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
20926 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20927 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050020928 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020929 does not support resumed sessions.
20930
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020931ssl_s_key_alg : string
20932 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20933 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
20934 SSL/TLS transport layer.
20935
20936ssl_s_notafter : string
20937 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
20938 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20939 transport layer.
20940
20941ssl_s_notbefore : string
20942 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
20943 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20944 transport layer.
20945
20946ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20947 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20948 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20949 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20950 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20951 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20952 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020020953 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20954 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020955 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20956 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20957 LDAP v3.
20958 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20959 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20960
20961ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20962 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20963 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20964 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20965 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20966 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20967 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020020968 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20969 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020970 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20971 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20972 LDAP v3.
20973 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20974 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20975
20976ssl_s_serial : binary
20977 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
20978 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20979 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20980
20981ssl_s_sha1 : binary
20982 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
20983 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
20984 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
20985
20986ssl_s_sig_alg : string
20987 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20988 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20989 layer.
20990
20991ssl_s_version : integer
20992 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
20993 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020994
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200209957.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020996------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020998Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
20999sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
21000only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
21001For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
21002be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
21003can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
21004sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
21005for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
21006content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021007
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010021008Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
21009 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021010 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010021011 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
21012 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
21013 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
21014 sample expression). So be careful.
21015
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010021016distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
21017 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
21018 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
21019 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
21020 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
21021 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
21022 list of supported tokens.
21023
21024distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
21025 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
21026 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
21027 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
21028 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
21029 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
21030 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
21031 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
21032 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
21033 supported tokens.
21034
21035 Example :
21036 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
21037 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
21038 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
21039 # send large files to the big farm
21040 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
21041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021042payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021043 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021044 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
21045 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021047payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
21048 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021049 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021050 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021052req.len : integer
21053req_len : integer (deprecated)
21054 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21055 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21056 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21057 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21058 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021059 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021060 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
21061 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021063req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21064 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021065 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
21066 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
21067 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
21068 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021069
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021070 ACL derivatives :
21071 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021073req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21074 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21075 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21076 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
21077 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021078
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021079 ACL derivatives :
21080 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021082 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021084req.proto_http : boolean
21085req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
21086 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
21087 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
21088 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
21089 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
21090 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
21091 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
21092 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021094 Example:
21095 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
21096 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21097 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020021098 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021100req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
21101rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21102 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
21103 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
21104 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
21105 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
21106 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
21107 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
21108 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021110 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
21111 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
21112 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
21113 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
21114 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
21115 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021117 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021118 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021120 Example :
21121 listen tse-farm
21122 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
21123 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
21124 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
21125 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
21126 # apply RDP cookie persistence
21127 persist rdp-cookie
21128 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
21129 # This is only useful makes sense if
21130 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
21131 stick-table type string size 204800
21132 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
21133 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
21134 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021136 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021137 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021139req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
21140rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
21141 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
21142 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
21143 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
21144 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021146 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021147 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021148
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021149req.ssl_alpn : string
21150 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
21151 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
21152 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
21153 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
21154 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
21155 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021156 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021157
21158 Examples :
21159 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21160 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021161 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021162 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021163 default_backend bk_default
21164
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021165req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
21166 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
21167 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020021168 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
21169 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
21170 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
21171 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
21172 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021174req.ssl_hello_type : integer
21175req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21176 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21177 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
21178 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21179 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21180 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
21181 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21182 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021184req.ssl_sni : string
21185req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
21186 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
21187 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
21188 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
21189 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21190 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020021191 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
21192 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
21193 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
21194 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
21195 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
21196 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
21197 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
21198 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
21199 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021201 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021202 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021204 Examples :
21205 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21206 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021207 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021208 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021209 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021210
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053021211req.ssl_st_ext : integer
21212 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
21213 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
21214 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
21215 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
21216 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
21217 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
21218 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
21219 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
21220 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
21221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021222req.ssl_ver : integer
21223req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
21224 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
21225 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
21226 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
21227 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
21228 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21229 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
21230 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021231 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021232 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021234 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021235 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021236
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021237res.len : integer
21238 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21239 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21240 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21241 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21242 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021243 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021244 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021245 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021247res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21248 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021249 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021250 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021251 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021252 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021254res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21255 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21256 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21257 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021258 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
21259 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021261 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021262
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020021263res.ssl_hello_type : integer
21264rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21265 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21266 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
21267 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21268 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21269 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
21270 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21271 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
21272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021273wait_end : boolean
21274 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
21275 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021276 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021277 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
21278 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021279 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021280 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
21281 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021283 Examples :
21284 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
21285 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
21286 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021288 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
21289 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21290 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
21291 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
21292 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
21293 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
21294 tcp-request content reject
21295
21296
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200212977.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021298--------------------------------------
21299
21300It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
21301This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
21302data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
21303its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
21304HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
21305content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
21306to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
21307more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
21308response are indexed.
21309
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010021310Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
21311 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
21312 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
21313 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
21314 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
21315 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
21316 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
21317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021318base : string
21319 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21320 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
21321 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
21322 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
21323 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
21324 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
21325 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
21326 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
21327
21328 ACL derivatives :
21329 base : exact string match
21330 base_beg : prefix match
21331 base_dir : subdir match
21332 base_dom : domain match
21333 base_end : suffix match
21334 base_len : length match
21335 base_reg : regex match
21336 base_sub : substring match
21337
21338base32 : integer
21339 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
21340 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
21341 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020021342 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
21343 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
21344 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021345
21346base32+src : binary
21347 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
21348 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
21349 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
21350 per-URL counters.
21351
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010021352baseq : string
21353 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21354 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
21355 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
21356 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
21357
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021358capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
21359 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
21360 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21361 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
21362
21363capture.req.method : string
21364 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
21365 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
21366 because it's allocated.
21367
21368capture.req.uri : string
21369 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
21370 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
21371 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
21372 allocated.
21373
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021374capture.req.ver : string
21375 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21376 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
21377 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
21378
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021379capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
21380 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
21381 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21382 The first entry is an index of 0.
21383 See also: "capture response header"
21384
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021385capture.res.ver : string
21386 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21387 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
21388 persistent flag.
21389
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021390req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021391 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
21392 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
21393 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021394
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020021395req.body_param([<name>) : string
21396 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
21397 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
21398 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
21399 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
21400 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
21401 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
21402 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
21403 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
21404 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
21405 given.
21406
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021407req.body_len : integer
21408 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
21409 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021410 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
21411 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021412
21413req.body_size : integer
21414 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021415 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
21416 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021418req.cook([<name>]) : string
21419cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21420 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21421 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
21422 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
21423 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
21424 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
21425 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
21426 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
21427 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
21428
21429 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021430 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
21431 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
21432 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
21433 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
21434 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
21435 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
21436 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
21437 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021439req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21440cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21441 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
21442 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021444req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
21445cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21446 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21447 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
21448 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
21449 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021451cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21452 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21453 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
21454 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
21455 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020021456 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021457 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
21458 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
21459 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
21460 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021462hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
21463 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
21464 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
21465 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
21466 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021467 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021469req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021470 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
21471 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
21472 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
21473 with headers such as User-Agent.
21474
21475 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21476 found.
21477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021478 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21479 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21480 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021481 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021483req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21484 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21485 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021486 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
21487 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021489req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021490 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
21491 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
21492 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
21493 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
21494 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
21495 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
21496 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
21497
21498 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21499 found.
21500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021501 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21502 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21503 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021504 with -1 being the last one.
21505
21506 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
21507 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021509 ACL derivatives :
21510 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
21511 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
21512 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
21513 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
21514 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
21515 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
21516 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
21517 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
21518
21519req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21520hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
21521 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21522 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021523 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
21524 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
21525 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
21526
21527 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
21528 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
21529 which contain more than one of certain headers.
21530
21531 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021532
21533req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
21534hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
21535 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
21536 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
21537 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010021538 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
21539 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
21540 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
21541 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
21542 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021543
21544 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
21545
21546 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021547
21548req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
21549hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
21550 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
21551 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
21552 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021553
21554 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
21555
21556 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021557
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010021558req.hdrs : string
21559 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
21560 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
21561 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
21562 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
21563
21564req.hdrs_bin : binary
21565 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
21566 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
21567 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
21568 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
21569 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
21570 names and values (length of 0 for both).
21571
21572 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010021573
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010021574 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
21575 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010021576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021577http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
21578 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
21579 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
21580 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
21581 basic auth is supported.
21582
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020021583http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
21584 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
21585 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
21586 performed on the data sent by the client.
21587 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
21588 Authorization one.
21589
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010021590http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
21591 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
21592 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
21593 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
21594 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021595 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
21596 basic auth is supported.
21597
21598 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010021599 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
21600 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
21601 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
21602 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021603
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021604http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021605 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
21606 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
21607 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021608
21609http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021610 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
21611 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
21612 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021613
21614http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021615 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
21616 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
21617 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021619http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020021620 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
21621 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021622 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
21623 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020021624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021625method : integer + string
21626 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
21627 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
21628 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
21629 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
21630 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
21631 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
21632 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021634 ACL derivatives :
21635 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021637 Example :
21638 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
21639 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
21640 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021642path : string
21643 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
21644 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
21645 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
21646 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
21647 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021648 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021649 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021651 ACL derivatives :
21652 path : exact string match
21653 path_beg : prefix match
21654 path_dir : subdir match
21655 path_dom : domain match
21656 path_end : suffix match
21657 path_len : length match
21658 path_reg : regex match
21659 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021660
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020021661pathq : string
21662 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
21663 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
21664 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
21665 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
21666 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
21667 result in both cases.
21668
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010021669query : string
21670 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
21671 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
21672 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
21673 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021674 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010021675 which stops before the question mark.
21676
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021677req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
21678 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
21679 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
21680 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
21681 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
21682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021683req.ver : string
21684req_ver : string (deprecated)
21685 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
21686 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
21687 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021689 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021690 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021691
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021692res.body : binary
21693 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
21694 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021695 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21696
21697 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021698
21699res.body_len : integer
21700 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
21701 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021702 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21703
21704 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021705
21706res.body_size : integer
21707 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
21708 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
21709 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
21710 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021711 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21712
21713 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021714
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010021715res.cache_hit : boolean
21716 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
21717 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
21718
21719res.cache_name : string
21720 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
21721 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
21722 empty string.
21723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021724res.comp : boolean
21725 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
21726 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
21727 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021729res.comp_algo : string
21730 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
21731 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
21732 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021734res.cook([<name>]) : string
21735scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21736 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21737 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021738 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
21739
21740 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020021741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021742 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021743 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020021744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021745res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21746scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21747 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
21748 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021749 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
21750
21751 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021753res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
21754scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21755 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21756 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021757 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
21758
21759 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021761res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021762 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
21763 on the headers within an HTTP response.
21764
21765 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
21766 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
21767
21768 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
21769
21770 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021772res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021773 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
21774 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21775
21776 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
21777 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
21778
21779 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021781res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
21782shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021783 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
21784 on the headers within an HTTP response.
21785
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050021786 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021787 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
21788
21789 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021791 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021792 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
21793 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
21794 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
21795 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
21796 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
21797 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
21798 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
21799 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021800
21801res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21802shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021803 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
21804 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21805
21806 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050021807 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021808
21809 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021811res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
21812shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021813 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
21814 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21815
21816 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
21817
21818 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021819
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021820res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
21821 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
21822 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
21823 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021824 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
21825
21826 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021828res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
21829shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021830 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
21831 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21832
21833 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
21834
21835 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021836
21837res.hdrs : string
21838 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
21839 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
21840 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021841 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
21842
21843 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021844
21845res.hdrs_bin : binary
21846 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
21847 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
21848 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
21849 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
21850 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
21851 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
21852 (length of 0 for both).
21853
21854 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
21855
21856 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
21857 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010021858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021859res.ver : string
21860resp_ver : string (deprecated)
21861 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021862 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
21863
21864 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021866 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021867 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010021868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021869set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21870 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21871 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020021872 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021873 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021875 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
21876 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021878status : integer
21879 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
21880 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021881 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
21882
21883 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021884
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020021885unique-id : string
21886 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
21887 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
21888 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
21889 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
21890 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
21891 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
21892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021893url : string
21894 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
21895 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
21896 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
21897 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
21898 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
21899 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
21900 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021902 ACL derivatives :
21903 url : exact string match
21904 url_beg : prefix match
21905 url_dir : subdir match
21906 url_dom : domain match
21907 url_end : suffix match
21908 url_len : length match
21909 url_reg : regex match
21910 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021912url_ip : ip
21913 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
21914 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
21915 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
21916 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020021917 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
21918 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021920url_port : integer
21921 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020021922 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021923
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021924urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
21925url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021926 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
21927 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021928 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
21929 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
21930 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
21931 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021932 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
21933 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021934 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
21935 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021937 ACL derivatives :
21938 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
21939 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
21940 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
21941 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
21942 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
21943 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
21944 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
21945 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021946
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021948 Example :
21949 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
21950 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
21951 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
21952 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021953
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030021954urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021955 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
21956 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
21957 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020021958
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020021959url32 : integer
21960 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
21961 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
21962 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
21963 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
21964 is an unsigned integer.
21965
21966url32+src : binary
21967 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
21968 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
21969 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
21970
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020021971
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200219727.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021973---------------------------------------
21974
21975This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
21976used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
21977purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
21978There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
21979or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
21980any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
21981for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
21982
21983internal.htx.data : integer
21984 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
21985 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21986
21987internal.htx.free : integer
21988 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
21989 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21990
21991internal.htx.free_data : integer
21992 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
21993 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21994
21995internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010021996 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
21997 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
21998 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021999
22000internal.htx.nbblks : integer
22001 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
22002 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22003
22004internal.htx.size : integer
22005 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
22006 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22007
22008internal.htx.used : integer
22009 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
22010 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22011 direction.
22012
22013internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
22014 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22015 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
22016 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
22017 of the special value :
22018 * head : The oldest inserted block
22019 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022020 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022021
22022internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
22023 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22024 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
22025 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
22026 integer or one of the special value :
22027 * head : The oldest inserted block
22028 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022029 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022030
22031internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
22032 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22033 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
22034 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22035 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22036
22037 * head : The oldest inserted block
22038 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022039 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022040
22041internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
22042 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
22043 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
22044 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22045 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22046
22047 * head : The oldest inserted block
22048 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022049 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022050
22051internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
22052 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
22053 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
22054 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22055 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22056
22057 * head : The oldest inserted block
22058 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022059 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022060
22061internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
22062 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
22063 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
22064 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22065 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22066
22067 * head : The oldest inserted block
22068 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022069 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022070
22071internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
22072 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
22073 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
22074 it returns false.
22075
22076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200220777.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022078---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022079
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022080Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
22081every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020022082order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022084ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022085---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
22086FALSE always_false never match
22087HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
22088HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
22089HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010022090HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022091HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
22092HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
22093HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
22094HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020022095LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022096METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
22097METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
22098METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
22099METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
22100METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
22101METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
22102METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
22103METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
22104RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
22105REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
22106TRUE always_true always match
22107WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
22108---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022109
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010022110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221118. Logging
22112----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022113
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022114One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
22115provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
22116very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
22117provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
22118state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022119to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022120headers.
22121
22122In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
22123about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
22124send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
22125
22126 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
22127 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
22128 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
22129 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
22130 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022131 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060022132 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022133
22134The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
22135allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
22136as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
22137while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
22138real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
22139delay.
22140
22141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221428.1. Log levels
22143---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022144
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022145TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022146source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022147HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
22148in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
22149track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
22150syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
22151about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022152
22153
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221548.2. Log formats
22155----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022156
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022157HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022158and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
22159slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
22160options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022161
22162 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
22163 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
22164 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
22165 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
22166 extents.
22167
22168 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
22169 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
22170 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
22171 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
22172 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
22173
22174 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
22175 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
22176 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
22177 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
22178 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
22179
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020022180 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
22181 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
22182 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
22183 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
22184
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022185 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
22186
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022187Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
22188specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
22189field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
22190servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
22191always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
22192identifier.
22193
22194Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
22195 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
22196 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
22197 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
22198 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
22199
22200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222018.2.1. Default log format
22202-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022203
22204This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
22205as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
22206format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
22207
22208 Example :
22209 listen www
22210 mode http
22211 log global
22212 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22213
22214 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
22215 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
22216 (www/HTTP)
22217
22218 Field Format Extract from the example above
22219 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
22220 2 'Connect from' Connect from
22221 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
22222 4 'to' to
22223 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
22224 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
22225
22226Detailed fields description :
22227 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
22228 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
22229 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
22230 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
22231 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22232 and processed the connection.
22233 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
22234
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022235In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
22236"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
22237connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
22238
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022239It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
22240will eventually disappear.
22241
22242
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222438.2.2. TCP log format
22244---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022245
22246The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
22247is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
22248information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
22249counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
22250emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
22251environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
22252the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
22253sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022254specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022255not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22256
22257The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22258exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022259if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable can be used instead.
22260Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022261
22262 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
22263 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
22264 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022265 # or using the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable
22266 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022267
22268A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
22269are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022270
22271 Example :
22272 frontend fnt
22273 mode tcp
22274 option tcplog
22275 log global
22276 default_backend bck
22277
22278 backend bck
22279 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22280
22281 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
22282 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
22283 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
22284
22285 Field Format Extract from the example above
22286 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
22287 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
22288 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
22289 4 frontend_name fnt
22290 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
22291 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
22292 7 bytes_read* 212
22293 8 termination_state --
22294 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
22295 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22296
22297Detailed fields description :
22298 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022299 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022300 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22301 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022302 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022303 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022304 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022305
22306 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022307 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22308 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22309 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022310
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022311 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022312 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
22313 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022314 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
22315 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
22316 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
22317 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022318
22319 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22320 and processed the connection.
22321
22322 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22323 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22324 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
22325 applications.
22326
22327 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22328 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22329 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22330 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
22331 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
22332
22333 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22334 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
22335 See "Timers" below for more details.
22336
22337 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22338 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
22339 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
22340 "Timers" below for more details.
22341
22342 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022343 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022344 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
22345 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
22346 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
22347 details.
22348
22349 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
22350 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
22351 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
22352 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
22353 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
22354
22355 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
22356 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
22357 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
22358 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
22359 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
22360 for more details.
22361
22362 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022363 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022364 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
22365 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
22366 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022367 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022368
22369 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
22370 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
22371 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
22372 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
22373 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
22374 caused by a denial of service attack.
22375
22376 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
22377 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
22378 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
22379 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
22380 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
22381 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
22382 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
22383 denial of service attack.
22384
22385 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
22386 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
22387 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
22388 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
22389 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
22390 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
22391 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
22392 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
22393 be processed than on other servers.
22394
22395 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
22396 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
22397 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
22398 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022399 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022400 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
22401 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
22402 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
22403 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
22404 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
22405 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
22406 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
22407 should not be attributed to the logged server.
22408
22409 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22410 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
22411 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
22412 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
22413 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
22414 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022415 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022416 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
22417
22418 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22419 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
22420 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
22421 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
22422 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
22423 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022424 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022425 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
22426 occurs.
22427
22428
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200224298.2.3. HTTP log format
22430----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022431
22432The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
22433is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
22434the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
22435are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
22436emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
22437generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
22438"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
22439which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022440frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
22441is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022442
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022443The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22444exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022445if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable can be used
22446instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022447
22448 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
22449 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
22450 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
22451
22452And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
22453this exact string:
22454
22455 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
22456 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
22457 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
22458 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022459 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable
22460 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022461
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022462Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
22463slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
22464with a star ('*') after the field name below.
22465
22466 Example :
22467 frontend http-in
22468 mode http
22469 option httplog
22470 log global
22471 default_backend bck
22472
22473 backend static
22474 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22475
22476 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
22477 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
22478 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022479 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022480
22481 Field Format Extract from the example above
22482 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
22483 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022484 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022485 4 frontend_name http-in
22486 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022487 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022488 7 status_code 200
22489 8 bytes_read* 2750
22490 9 captured_request_cookie -
22491 10 captured_response_cookie -
22492 11 termination_state ----
22493 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
22494 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22495 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
22496 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
22497 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022498
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022499Detailed fields description :
22500 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022501 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022502 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22503 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022504 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022505 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022506 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022507
22508 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022509 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22510 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22511 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022512
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022513 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022514 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022515
22516 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22517 and processed the connection.
22518
22519 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22520 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22521 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
22522
22523 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22524 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22525 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22526 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
22527 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
22528 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
22529
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022530 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
22531 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
22532 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022533 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022534 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
22535 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022536 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022537 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022538
22539 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22540 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022541 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022542
22543 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22544 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022545 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
22546 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022547
22548 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
22549 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
22550 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
22551 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
22552 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022553 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
22554 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022555
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022556 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022557 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
22558 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
22559 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
22560 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
22561 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
22562 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022563 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022564
22565 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022566 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
22567 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022568
22569 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
22570 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022571 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022572 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
22573 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
22574 overflowing.
22575
22576 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
22577 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
22578 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
22579 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
22580 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
22581 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
22582 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
22583 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
22584
22585 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
22586 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
22587 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
22588 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
22589 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
22590 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
22591 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
22592 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
22593
22594 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
22595 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
22596 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
22597 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
22598 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
22599 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
22600 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
22601
22602 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022603 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022604 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
22605 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
22606 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022607 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022608 system.
22609
22610 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
22611 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
22612 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
22613 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
22614 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
22615 caused by a denial of service attack.
22616
22617 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
22618 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
22619 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
22620 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
22621 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
22622 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
22623 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
22624 denial of service attack.
22625
22626 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
22627 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
22628 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
22629 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
22630 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
22631 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
22632 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
22633 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
22634 processed than on other servers.
22635
22636 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
22637 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
22638 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
22639 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022640 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022641 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
22642 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
22643 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
22644 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
22645 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
22646 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
22647 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
22648 should not be attributed to the logged server.
22649
22650 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22651 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
22652 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
22653 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
22654 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
22655 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022656 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022657 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
22658
22659 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22660 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
22661 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
22662 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
22663 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
22664 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022665 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022666 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
22667 occurs.
22668
22669 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
22670 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
22671 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
22672 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
22673 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
22674 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
22675 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
22676 cookies" below for more details.
22677
22678 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
22679 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
22680 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
22681 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
22682 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
22683 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
22684 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
22685 and cookies" below for more details.
22686
22687 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
22688 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
22689 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
22690 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
22691 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
22692 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
22693 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
22694 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
22695
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022696
226978.2.4. HTTPS log format
22698----------------------
22699
22700The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
22701extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
22702information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
22703frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
22704end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
22705matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
22706sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
22707dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
22708"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22709
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022710The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22711exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022712if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable can be used
22713instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022714
22715 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
22716 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
22717 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
22718 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022719 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022720 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable
22721 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022722
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022723This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
22724appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
22725HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022726
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022727 Example :
22728 frontend https-in
22729 mode http
22730 option httpslog
22731 log global
22732 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
22733 default_backend bck
22734
22735 backend static
22736 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
22737
22738 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
22739 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
22740 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022741 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
22742 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022743
22744 Field Format Extract from the example above
22745 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
22746 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
22747 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
22748 4 frontend_name https-in
22749 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
22750 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
22751 7 status_code 200
22752 8 bytes_read* 2750
22753 9 captured_request_cookie -
22754 10 captured_response_cookie -
22755 11 termination_state ----
22756 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
22757 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22758 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
22759 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
22760 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010022761 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020022762 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022763 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
22764 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022765
22766Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010022767 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
22768 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
22769 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022770
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020022771 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
22772 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
22773 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050022774 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020022775 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022776
22777 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
22778 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
22779 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
22780 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
22781
22782 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
22783 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
22784 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
22785 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
22786
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020022787 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
22788 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
22789 can be shared by multiple requests.
22790
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022791 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
22792 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
22793 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
22794 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
22795 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
22796
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022797 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
22798
22799 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
22800
22801
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100228028.2.5. Error log format
22803-----------------------
22804
22805When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
22806protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
22807unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
22808line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
22809"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
22810will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
22811logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
22812
22813The default format looks like this :
22814
22815 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
22816 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
22817 Connection error during SSL handshake
22818
22819 Field Format Extract from the example above
22820 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
22821 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
22822 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
22823 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
22824 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
22825
22826These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
22827failures.
22828
22829By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
22830above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
22831defined format.
22832
22833An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
22834source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
22835number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
22836internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
22837error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
22838the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
22839certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
22840indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
22841indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
22842ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
22843are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
22844would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
22845regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
22846
22847 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010022848 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010022849 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
22850 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
22851
22852
228538.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022854------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022855
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022856When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
22857ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
22858a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
22859formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
22860looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
22861and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022862
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022863HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022864Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
22865separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
22866prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
22867
22868Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
22869variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022870("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022871
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010022872If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020022873as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010022874less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
22875the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
22876
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020022877Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
22878"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
22879delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
22880preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022881
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022882Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
22883'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
22884https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
22885such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
22886
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022887Flags are :
22888 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022889 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022890 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
22891 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022892
22893 Example:
22894
22895 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
22896 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
22897
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022898 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
22899
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022900Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
22901
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022902 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022903 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022904 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
22905 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
22906 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022907 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
22908 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
22909 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022910 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000022911 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000022912 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000022913 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000022914 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000022915 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
22916 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010022917 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020022918 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022919 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010022920 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022921 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020022922 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080022923 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022924 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
22925 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
22926 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
22927 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
22928 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022929 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022930 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022931 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022932 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022933 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022934 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
22935 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022936 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
22937 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
22938 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022939 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022940 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
22941 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022942 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022943 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
22944 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
22945 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020022946 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020022947 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022948 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
22949 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
22950 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
22951 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020022952 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022953 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022954 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022955 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010022956 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022957 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022958 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
22959 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
22960 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022961 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022962 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
22963 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022964 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022965 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
22966 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020022967 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022968 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022969 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022970 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022971
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022972 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022973
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010022974
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200229758.3. Advanced logging options
22976-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022977
22978Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
22979just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
22980options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
22981for more information about their usage.
22982
22983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200229848.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
22985------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022986
22987It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022988HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022989commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
22990monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
22991ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
22992
22993 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
22994 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
22995 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
22996 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
22997
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020022998 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
22999 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023000
23001 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
23002 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
23003 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
23004
23005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200230068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
23007----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023008
23009The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
23010what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
23011or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023012"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023013just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
23014log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
23015after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
23016is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
23017with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
23018with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
23019
23020
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200230218.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
23022------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023023
23024Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
23025for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
23026"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
23027retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
23028raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
23029a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
23030file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
23031you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
23032"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
23033
23034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200230358.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
23036--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023037
23038Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
23039multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
23040them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
23041"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
23042logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
23043error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
23044and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
23045too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
23046useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
23047alternative.
23048
23049
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200230508.4. Timing events
23051------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023052
23053Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
23054reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
23055the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
23056frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023057mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
23058addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
23059
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010023060Timings events in HTTP mode:
23061
23062 first request 2nd request
23063 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
23064 t tr t tr ...
23065 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
23066 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
23067 :<---- Tq ---->: :
23068 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023069 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010023070 :<--------- Ta --------->:
23071
23072Timings events in TCP mode:
23073
23074 TCP session
23075 |<----------------->|
23076 t t
23077 ---|----|----|----|----|---
23078 | Th Tw Tc Td |
23079 |<------ Tt ------->|
23080
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023081 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023082 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023083 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
23084 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
23085 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023086 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023087 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
23088 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
23089 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
23090 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023091
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023092 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
23093 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
23094 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023095 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
23096 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
23097 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
23098 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
23099 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
23100 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023101
23102 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
23103 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
23104 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
23105 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
23106 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
23107 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
23108 request typed by hand during a test.
23109
23110 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
23111 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023112 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023113 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
23114 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
23115 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
23116 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023117
23118 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
23119 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
23120 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
23121 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
23122 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
23123
23124 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
23125 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
23126 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
23127 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
23128 connection never established.
23129
23130 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
23131 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
23132 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
23133 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
23134 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
23135 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
23136 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
23137 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
23138 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
23139 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
23140 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
23141
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023142 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
23143 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
23144 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
23145 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
23146 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
23147 by subtracting other timers when valid :
23148
23149 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
23150
23151 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
23152 "Ta" can never be negative.
23153
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023154 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
23155 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023156 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
23157 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023158 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023159
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023160 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023161
23162 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023163 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
23164 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023165
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023166 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
23167 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
23168 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
23169 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
23170 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
23171 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
23172 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
23173 prefixed with a '+' sign.
23174
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023175These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
23176protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
23177that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023178due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
23179"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
23180that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023181
23182Most common cases :
23183
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023184 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
23185 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
23186 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
23187 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
23188 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023189 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023190 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
23191 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
23192 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
23193 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
23194 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020023195 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023196
23197 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
23198 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
23199 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
23200 of ms on remote networks.
23201
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023202 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
23203 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
23204 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023205
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023206 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
23207 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023208 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023209 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
23210 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
23211 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
23212 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
23213 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
23214 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023215
23216Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
23217
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023218 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023219 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023220 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023221
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023222 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023223 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
23224 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
23225
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023226 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023227 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
23228 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
23229 flags.
23230
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023231 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
23232 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023233 Check the session termination flags, then check the
23234 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
23235 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
23236 the client connection was maintained open.
23237
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023238 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023239 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023240 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023241 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
23242
23243
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200232448.5. Session state at disconnection
23245-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023246
23247TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
23248"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
232492-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
23250each of which has a special meaning :
23251
23252 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
23253 session to terminate :
23254
23255 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
23256
23257 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
23258 server explicitly refused it.
23259
23260 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
23261 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
23262 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
23263 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023264 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023265
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023266 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023267 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023268
23269 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
23270 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
23271 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
23272 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
23273 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
23274
23275 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
23276 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
23277 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
23278 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
23279 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
23280
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023281 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090023282 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
23283
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023284 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070023285 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
23286 backup connections when going up.
23287
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023288 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020023289
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023290 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
23291 send or receive data.
23292
23293 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
23294 send or receive data.
23295
23296 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
23297 with nothing left in the buffers.
23298
23299 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
23300
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010023301 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023302 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
23303
23304 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
23305 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
23306 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
23307 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
23308 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
23309
23310 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
23311 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
23312
23313 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
23314 server (HTTP only).
23315
23316 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
23317
23318 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
23319 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
23320 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
23321
23322 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
23323 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
23324 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
23325
23326 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
23327
23328 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
23329 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
23330
23331 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
23332 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
23333 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
23334
23335 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
23336 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020023337 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
23338 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023339
23340 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
23341 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
23342 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
23343 another server.
23344
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023345 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023346 server.
23347
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023348 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
23349 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
23350 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
23351 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23352
23353 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
23354 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
23355 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
23356 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23357
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020023358 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
23359 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
23360 "use-server" rule).
23361
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023362 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23363
23364 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
23365 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
23366
23367 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
23368
23369 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
23370 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
23371 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
23372
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023373 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
23374 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023375 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023376 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
23377 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
23378
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023379 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
23380
23381 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
23382 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
23383
23384 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
23385
23386 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23387
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023388The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
23389was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023390helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
23391starvation, attacks, etc...
23392
23393The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
23394alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
23395easier finding and understanding.
23396
23397 Flags Reason
23398
23399 -- Normal termination.
23400
23401 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023402 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
23403 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023404 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
23405
23406 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
23407 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023408 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
23409 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023410 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
23411 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023412
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023413 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23414 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023415 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023416
23417 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
23418 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
23419 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
23420
23421 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
23422 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
23423 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
23424 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
23425 the server takes too long to respond.
23426
23427 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
23428 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
23429 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
23430 long a time to respond.
23431
23432 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
23433 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
23434 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023435 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023436 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
23437 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023438
23439 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
23440 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
23441 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
23442 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
23443 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020023444 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023445 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
23446 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
23447 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
23448 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
23449 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
23450 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
23451 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
23452 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023453 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023454 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
23455 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
23456 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023457
23458 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
23459 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023460 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
23461 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
23462 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
23463 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023464
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023465 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023466 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
23467
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023468 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023469 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
23470 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023471 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023472 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
23473 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
23474
23475 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
23476 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
23477 503 or 504 here.
23478
23479 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023480 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023481 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
23482 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
23483 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
23484
23485 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23486 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023487 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023488 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023489 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023490
23491 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
23492 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
23493 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
23494 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
23495 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
23496 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023497 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023498
23499 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
23500 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
23501 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
23502 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
23503 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
23504 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
23505 solution is to fix the application.
23506
23507 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
23508 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
23509 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
23510 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
23511 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
23512 external attacks.
23513
23514 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070023515 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023516 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023517 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
23518 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
23519
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023520 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
23521 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
23522 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023523 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020023524 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023525
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023526 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
23527 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
23528 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
23529 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023530 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
23531 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
23532 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
23533 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020023534 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
23535 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
23536 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
23537 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023538
23539 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
23540 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
23541 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020023542 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
23543 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
23544 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
23545 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023546
23547 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
23548 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
23549 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
23550 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
23551
23552 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
23553 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
23554 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
23555 only be solved by proper system tuning.
23556
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023557The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023558persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023559important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
23560re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
23561
23562 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
23563
23564 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
23565 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
23566 set on a GET request.
23567
23568 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
23569 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023570 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023571 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
23572
23573 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
23574 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
23575 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
23576
23577 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
23578 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
23579 already got a cookie.
23580
23581 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
23582 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
23583 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
23584 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
23585 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
23586
23587 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
23588 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
23589 new cookie was inserted in the response.
23590
23591 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
23592 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
23593 new cookie was inserted in the response.
23594
23595 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
23596 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
23597
23598 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
23599 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
23600 then advertised in the response.
23601
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236038.6. Non-printable characters
23604-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023605
23606In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
23607consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
23608converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
23609prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
23610being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
23611escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
23612is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
23613'}' when logging headers.
23614
23615Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
23616issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
23617containing spaces is "User-Agent".
23618
23619Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
23620the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
23621performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
23622
23623
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236248.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
23625---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023626
23627Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
23628achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023629section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023630cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
23631the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
23632the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023633locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023634not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
23635user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
23636a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
23637wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
23638
23639 Examples :
23640 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
23641 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
23642
23643 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
23644 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
23645
23646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236478.8. Capturing HTTP headers
23648---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023649
23650Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
23651proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
23652the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
23653server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
23654
23655Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
23656response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023657section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023658
23659It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010023660time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
23661appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023662are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
23663and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
23664follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
23665request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
23666in the logs.
23667
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020023668As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
23669frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
23670an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
23671
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023672 Example :
23673 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
23674 listen proxy-out
23675 mode http
23676 option httplog
23677 option logasap
23678 log global
23679 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
23680
23681 # log the name of the virtual server
23682 capture request header Host len 20
23683
23684 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
23685 capture request header Content-Length len 10
23686
23687 # log the beginning of the referrer
23688 capture request header Referer len 20
23689
23690 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
23691 capture response header Server len 20
23692
23693 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
23694 capture response header Content-Length len 10
23695
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023696 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023697 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
23698
23699 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
23700 capture response header Via len 20
23701
23702 # log the URL location during a redirection
23703 capture response header Location len 20
23704
23705 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
23706 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
23707 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23708 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
23709 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
23710
23711 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
23712 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
23713 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23714 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023715 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023716
23717 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
23718 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
23719 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23720 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
23721 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023722 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023723
23724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200237258.9. Examples of logs
23726---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023727
23728These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
23729them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
23730reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
23731
23732 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
23733 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
23734 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
23735
23736 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
23737 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
23738
23739 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
23740 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
23741 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
23742
23743 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
23744 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
23745
23746 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
23747 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
23748 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
23749
23750 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010023751 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023752 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
23753 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
23754
23755 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
23756 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
23757 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
23758
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020023759 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
23760 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
23761 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
23762 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023763 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020023764 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023765
23766 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023767 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023768
23769 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
23770 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
23771 Nothing was sent to any server.
23772
23773 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
23774 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
23775
23776 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
23777 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023778 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023779 send a 408 return code to the client.
23780
23781 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
23782 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
23783
23784 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
23785 5 seconds ("c----").
23786
23787 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
23788 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023789 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023790
23791 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023792 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023793 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
23794 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
23795 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
23796 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
23797 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010023798
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020023799
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200238009. Supported filters
23801--------------------
23802
23803Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
23804accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
23805unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
23806
23807See also : "filter"
23808
238099.1. Trace
23810----------
23811
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010023812filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023813
23814 Arguments:
23815 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
23816 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
23817
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010023818 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023819
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023820 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023821 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
23822 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
23823 amount of the parsed data.
23824
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023825 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010023826
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023827This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
23828callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
23829information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
23830filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
23831
23832Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
23833tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
23834a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
23835
23836
238379.2. HTTP compression
23838---------------------
23839
23840filter compression
23841
23842The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
23843keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023844when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
23845fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
23846done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
23847explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
23848filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
23849listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23850order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023851
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023852See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
23853 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023854
23855
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200238569.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
23857--------------------------------------------
23858
23859filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
23860
23861 Arguments :
23862
23863 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
23864 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
23865 parsed.
23866
23867 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
23868 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
23869 part must be placed in its own scope.
23870
23871The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
23872external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023873streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020023874exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
23875also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
23876
23877SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
23878the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
23879
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010023880For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020023881"doc/SPOE.txt".
23882
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100238839.4. Cache
23884----------
23885
23886filter cache <name>
23887
23888 Arguments :
23889
23890 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
23891
23892The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
23893"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023894cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023895other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
23896case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
23897is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
23898filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010023899listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23900order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010023901
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023902See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
23903 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
23904
23905
239069.5. Fcgi-app
23907-------------
23908
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040023909filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023910
23911 Arguments :
23912
23913 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
23914
23915The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
23916request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
23917reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
23918used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
23919implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
23920used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
23921fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
23922used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23923order.
23924
23925See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
23926 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
23927
23928
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100239299.6. OpenTracing
23930----------------
23931
23932The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
23933HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
23934of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
23935Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
23936
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023937This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023938
23939The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
23940HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
23941participates in the work of HAProxy.
23942
23943filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
23944
23945 Arguments :
23946
23947 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
23948 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
23949 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
23950 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
23951 OpenTracing filters.
23952
23953 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
23954 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
23955 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
23956 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
23957 filter must have its own scope defined.
23958
23959More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020023960of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023961
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +0200239629.7. Bandwidth limitation
23963--------------------------
23964
23965filter bwlim-in <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
23966filter bwlim-out <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
23967filter bwlim-in <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
23968filter bwlim-out <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
23969
23970 Arguments :
23971
23972 <name> is the filter name that will be used by 'set-bandwidth-limit'
23973 actions to reference a specific bandwidth limitation filter.
23974
23975 <size> is max number of bytes that can be forwarded over the period.
23976 The value must be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
23977 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
23978 expressed in bytes.
23979
23980 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
23981 describes what elements will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
23982 and used to select which table entry to update the counters. It
23983 must be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
23984
23985 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
23986 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. It can
23987 be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
23988
23989 <time> is the default time period used to evaluate the bandwidth
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050023990 limitation rate. It can be specified for per-stream bandwidth
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020023991 limitation filters only. It follows the HAProxy time format and
23992 is expressed in milliseconds.
23993
23994 <min-size> is the optional minimum number of bytes forwarded at a time by
23995 a stream excluding the last packet that may be smaller. This
23996 value can be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
23997 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
23998 expressed in bytes.
23999
24000Bandwidth limitation filters should be used to restrict the data forwarding
24001speed at the stream level. By extension, such filters limit the network
24002bandwidth consumed by a resource. Several bandwidth limitation filters can be
24003used. For instance, it is possible to define a limit per source address to be
24004sure a client will never consume all the network bandwidth, thereby penalizing
24005other clients, and another one per stream to be able to fairly handle several
24006connections for a given client.
24007
24008The definition order of these filters is important. If several bandwidth
24009filters are enabled on a stream, the filtering will be applied in their
24010definition order. It is also important to understand the definition order of
24011the other filters have an influence. For instance, depending on the HTTP
24012compression filter is defined before or after a bandwidth limitation filter,
24013the limit will be applied on the compressed payload or not. The same is true
24014for the cache filter.
24015
24016There are two kinds of bandwidth limitation filters. The first one enforces a
24017default limit and is applied per stream. The second one uses a stickiness table
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050024018to enforce a limit equally divided between all streams sharing the same entry in
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024019the table.
24020
24021In addition, for a given filter, depending on the filter keyword used, the
24022limitation can be applied on incoming data, received from the client and
24023forwarded to a server, or on outgoing data, received from a server and sent to
24024the client. To apply a limit on incoming data, "bwlim-in" keyword must be
24025used. To apply it on outgoing data, "bwlim-out" keyword must be used. In both
24026cases, the bandwidth limitation is applied on forwarded data, at the stream
24027level.
24028
24029The bandwidth limitation is applied at the stream level and not at the
24030connection level. For multiplexed protocols (H2, H3 and FastCGI), the streams
24031of the same connection may have different limits.
24032
24033For a per-stream bandwidth limitation filter, default period and limit must be
24034defined. As their names suggest, they are the default values used to setup the
24035bandwidth limitation rate for a stream. However, for this kind of filter and
24036only this one, it is possible to redefine these values using sample expressions
24037when the filter is enabled with a TCP/HTTP "set-bandwidth-limit" action.
24038
24039For a shared bandwidth limitation filter, depending on whether it is applied on
24040incoming or outgoing data, the stickiness table used must store the
24041corresponding bytes rate information. "bytes_in_rate(<period>)" counter must be
24042stored to limit incoming data and "bytes_out_rate(<period>)" counter must be
24043used to limit outgoing data.
24044
24045Finally, it is possible to set the minimum number of bytes that a bandwidth
24046limitation filter can forward at a time for a given stream. It should be used
24047to not forward too small amount of data, to reduce the CPU usage. It must
24048carefully be defined. Too small, a value can increase the CPU usage. Too high,
24049it can increase the latency. It is also highly linked to the defined bandwidth
24050limit. If it is too close to the bandwidth limit, some pauses may be
24051experienced to not exceed the limit because too many bytes will be consumed at
24052a time. It is highly dependent on the filter configuration. A good idea is to
24053start with something around 2 TCP MSS, typically 2896 bytes, and tune it after
24054some experimentations.
24055
24056 Example:
24057 frontend http
24058 bind *:80
24059 mode http
24060
24061 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will share the download limit
24062 # of 10m/s with all other streams with the same source address.
24063 filter bwlim-out limit-by-src key src table limit-by-src limit 10m
24064
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050024065 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will be limited to download at 1m/s,
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024066 # independently of all other streams.
24067 filter bwlim-out limit-by-strm default-limit 1m default-period 1s
24068
24069 # Limit all streams to 1m/s (the default limit) and those accessing the
24070 # internal API to 100k/s. Limit each source address to 10m/s. The shared
24071 # limit is applied first. Both are limiting the download rate.
24072 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm
24073 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm limit 100k if { path_beg /internal }
24074 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-src
24075 ...
24076
24077 backend limit-by-src
24078 # The stickiness table used by <limit-by-src> filter
24079 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 3600s store bytes_out_rate(1s)
24080
24081See also : "tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit",
24082 "tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit",
24083 "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" and
24084 "http-response set-bandwidth-limit".
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024085
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002408610. FastCGI applications
24087-------------------------
24088
24089HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
24090feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
24091the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
24092FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
24093servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
24094FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
24095backend.
24096
24097HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
24098application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
24099connection.
24100
2410110.1. Setup
24102-----------
24103
2410410.1.1. Fcgi-app section
24105--------------------------
24106
24107fcgi-app <name>
24108 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
24109 document root must be defined.
24110
24111acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
24112 Declare or complete an access list.
24113
24114 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
24115 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
24116 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
24117 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
24118 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
24119
24120docroot <path>
24121 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
24122 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
24123 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
24124
24125index <script-name>
24126 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
24127 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
24128 is an optional setting.
24129
24130 Example :
24131 index index.php
24132
24133log-stderr global
24134log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010024135 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024136 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
24137
24138 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
24139 default STDERR messages are ignored.
24140
24141pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24142 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
24143 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
24144 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24145
24146 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
24147 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
24148 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
24149 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
24150
24151 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
24152 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
24153
24154path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024155 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024156 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
24157 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
24158 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
24159 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
24160 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
24161 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
24162 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024163
24164 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024165 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024166 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
24167 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
24168 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
24169 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024170
24171 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024172 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
24173 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024174
24175option get-values
24176no option get-values
24177 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
24178
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024179 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024180 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
24181
24182 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
24183 application will accept.
24184
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020024185 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
24186 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024187
24188 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050024189 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024190 option is disabled.
24191
24192 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
24193 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
24194 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
24195 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
24196 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
24197 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
24198
24199option keep-conn
24200no option keep-conn
24201 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
24202 sending a response.
24203
24204 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
24205 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
24206
24207option max-reqs <reqs>
24208 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
24209 accept.
24210
24211 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
24212 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
24213 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
24214 to 1.
24215
24216option mpxs-conns
24217no option mpxs-conns
24218 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
24219
24220 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
24221 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
24222
24223set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24224 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
24225 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
24226 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
24227 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24228
24229 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
24230 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
24231 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
24232
24233 Example :
24234 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
24235 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
24236
24237 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
24238
24239
2424010.1.2. Proxy section
24241---------------------
24242
24243use-fcgi-app <name>
24244 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
24245
24246 Arguments :
24247 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
24248
24249 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
24250 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
24251 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
24252 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
24253 application may be defined at a time per backend.
24254
24255 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
24256 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
24257 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
24258 application are evaluated.
24259
24260
2426110.1.3. Example
24262---------------
24263
24264 frontend front-http
24265 mode http
24266 bind *:80
24267 bind *:
24268
24269 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
24270 default_backend back-static
24271
24272 backend back-static
24273 mode http
24274 server www A.B.C.D:80
24275
24276 backend back-dynamic
24277 mode http
24278 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
24279 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
24280
24281 fcgi-app php-fpm
24282 log-stderr global
24283 option keep-conn
24284
24285 docroot /var/www/my-app
24286 index index.php
24287 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
24288
24289
2429010.2. Default parameters
24291------------------------
24292
24293A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
24294the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024295script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024296applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
24297
24298 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24299 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
24300 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
24301 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
24302 | | |
24303 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24304 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
24305 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
24306 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
24307 | | application. |
24308 | | |
24309 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24310 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
24311 | | the request. It may not be set. |
24312 | | |
24313 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24314 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
24315 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
24316 | | the application's configuration. |
24317 | | |
24318 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24319 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
24320 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
24321 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
24322 | | |
24323 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24324 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
24325 | | following the part that identifies the script |
24326 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
24327 | | be defined. |
24328 | | |
24329 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24330 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
24331 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
24332 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
24333 | | is not set too. |
24334 | | |
24335 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24336 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
24337 | | set. |
24338 | | |
24339 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24340 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
24341 | | the request. |
24342 | | |
24343 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24344 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
24345 | | client as part of user authentication. |
24346 | | |
24347 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24348 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
24349 | | script to process the request. |
24350 | | |
24351 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24352 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
24353 | | |
24354 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24355 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
24356 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
24357 | | |
24358 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24359 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
24360 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
24361 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
24362 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
24363 | | |
24364 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24365 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
24366 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
24367 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
24368 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
24369 | | side. |
24370 | | |
24371 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24372 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
24373 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
24374 | | connected to. |
24375 | | |
24376 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24377 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
24378 | | |
24379 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020024380 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
24381 | | current HAProxy version. |
24382 | | |
24383 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024384 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
24385 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
24386 | | |
24387 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24388
24389
2439010.3. Limitations
24391------------------
24392
24393The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
24394way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
24395during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
24396establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
24397application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
24398or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
24399message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
24400these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
24401and HTTP servers under the same backend.
24402
24403Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
24404request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
24405requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
24406
24407About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
24408into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
24409fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
24410"http-request" ones.
24411
24412Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
24413FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
24414processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
24415must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
24416here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010024417
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024418
2441911. Address formats
24420-------------------
24421
24422Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
24423address.
24424
24425This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
24426The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
24427of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
24428equivalent is '::'.
24429
24430Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
24431is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
24432
24433This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
24434family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
24435
24436Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
24437configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
24438use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
24439'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
24440
24441Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
24442socket type and the transport method.
24443
24444
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002444511.1. Address family prefixes
24446-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024447
24448'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
24449
24450'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
24451 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
24452 listening.
24453
24454'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
24455 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
24456 on the statement using this address, a port or
24457 a port range may or must be specified.
24458
24459'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24460 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
24461 using this address, a port or a port range
24462 may or must be specified.
24463
24464'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24465 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
24466 using this address, a port or a port range
24467 may or must be specified.
24468
24469'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
24470 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
24471 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
24472 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
24473 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
24474 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
24475
24476'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
24477 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
24478 start by slash '/'.
24479
24480
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002448111.2. Socket type prefixes
24482--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024483
24484Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
24485type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
24486this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
24487This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
24488but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
24489
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024490Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should instead use
24491use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes". However these can
24492sometimes be convenient, for example in combination with inherited sockets
24493known by their file descriptor number, in which case the address family is "fd"
24494and the socket type must be declared.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024495
24496If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
24497they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
24498report this to the maintainers.
24499
24500'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
24501 to "stream"
24502
24503'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
24504 to "datagram".
24505
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024506'quic+<family>@<address>' forces socket type to "datagram" and transport
24507 method to "stream".
24508
24509
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024510
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002451111.3. Protocol prefixes
24512-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024513
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024514'quic4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24515 an IPv4 address but socket type is forced to
24516 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
24517 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
24518 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024519 must be specified. It is equivalent to
24520 "quic+ipv4@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024521
24522'quic6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24523 an IPv6 address but socket type is forced to
24524 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
24525 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
24526 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024527 must be specified. It is equivalent to
24528 "quic+ipv6@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024529
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024530'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
24531 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
24532 socket type and transport method is forced to
24533 "stream". Depending on the statement using
24534 this address, a port or a port range can or
24535 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
24536 of 'stream+ip@'.
24537
24538'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24539 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
24540 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
24541 statement using this address, a port or port
24542 range can or must be specified.
24543 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
24544
24545'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24546 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
24547 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
24548 statement using this address, a port or port
24549 range can or must be specified.
24550 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
24551
24552'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
24553 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
24554 socket type and transport method is forced to
24555 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
24556 this address, a port or a port range can or
24557 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
24558 of 'dgram+ip@'.
24559
24560'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24561 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
24562 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
24563 the statement using this address, a port or
24564 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010024565 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024566
24567'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24568 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
24569 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
24570 the statement using this address, a port or
24571 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010024572 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024573
24574'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
24575 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
24576 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
24577
24578'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
24579 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
24580 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
24581
24582In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
24583QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
24584
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010024585/*
24586 * Local variables:
24587 * fill-column: 79
24588 * End:
24589 */